[ARM] Fix assembly comment syntax in -mprint-tune-info
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / tree-vrp.c
blobe058d8d0eff1cbbb2cf63a76fc63eebe81e213d5
1 /* Support routines for Value Range Propagation (VRP).
2 Copyright (C) 2005-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Diego Novillo <dnovillo@redhat.com>.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "config.h"
22 #include "system.h"
23 #include "coretypes.h"
24 #include "backend.h"
25 #include "insn-codes.h"
26 #include "rtl.h"
27 #include "tree.h"
28 #include "gimple.h"
29 #include "cfghooks.h"
30 #include "tree-pass.h"
31 #include "ssa.h"
32 #include "optabs-tree.h"
33 #include "gimple-pretty-print.h"
34 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
35 #include "flags.h"
36 #include "fold-const.h"
37 #include "stor-layout.h"
38 #include "calls.h"
39 #include "cfganal.h"
40 #include "gimple-fold.h"
41 #include "tree-eh.h"
42 #include "gimple-iterator.h"
43 #include "gimple-walk.h"
44 #include "tree-cfg.h"
45 #include "tree-ssa-loop-manip.h"
46 #include "tree-ssa-loop-niter.h"
47 #include "tree-ssa-loop.h"
48 #include "tree-into-ssa.h"
49 #include "tree-ssa.h"
50 #include "intl.h"
51 #include "cfgloop.h"
52 #include "tree-scalar-evolution.h"
53 #include "tree-ssa-propagate.h"
54 #include "tree-chrec.h"
55 #include "tree-ssa-threadupdate.h"
56 #include "tree-ssa-scopedtables.h"
57 #include "tree-ssa-threadedge.h"
58 #include "omp-general.h"
59 #include "target.h"
60 #include "case-cfn-macros.h"
61 #include "params.h"
62 #include "alloc-pool.h"
63 #include "domwalk.h"
64 #include "tree-cfgcleanup.h"
66 #define VR_INITIALIZER { VR_UNDEFINED, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE, NULL }
68 /* Allocation pools for tree-vrp allocations. */
69 static object_allocator<value_range> vrp_value_range_pool ("Tree VRP value ranges");
70 static bitmap_obstack vrp_equiv_obstack;
72 /* Set of SSA names found live during the RPO traversal of the function
73 for still active basic-blocks. */
74 static sbitmap *live;
76 /* Return true if the SSA name NAME is live on the edge E. */
78 static bool
79 live_on_edge (edge e, tree name)
81 return (live[e->dest->index]
82 && bitmap_bit_p (live[e->dest->index], SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)));
85 /* Local functions. */
86 static int compare_values (tree val1, tree val2);
87 static int compare_values_warnv (tree val1, tree val2, bool *);
88 static tree vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code,
89 tree, tree, bool, bool *,
90 bool *);
92 /* Location information for ASSERT_EXPRs. Each instance of this
93 structure describes an ASSERT_EXPR for an SSA name. Since a single
94 SSA name may have more than one assertion associated with it, these
95 locations are kept in a linked list attached to the corresponding
96 SSA name. */
97 struct assert_locus
99 /* Basic block where the assertion would be inserted. */
100 basic_block bb;
102 /* Some assertions need to be inserted on an edge (e.g., assertions
103 generated by COND_EXPRs). In those cases, BB will be NULL. */
104 edge e;
106 /* Pointer to the statement that generated this assertion. */
107 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
109 /* Predicate code for the ASSERT_EXPR. Must be COMPARISON_CLASS_P. */
110 enum tree_code comp_code;
112 /* Value being compared against. */
113 tree val;
115 /* Expression to compare. */
116 tree expr;
118 /* Next node in the linked list. */
119 assert_locus *next;
122 /* If bit I is present, it means that SSA name N_i has a list of
123 assertions that should be inserted in the IL. */
124 static bitmap need_assert_for;
126 /* Array of locations lists where to insert assertions. ASSERTS_FOR[I]
127 holds a list of ASSERT_LOCUS_T nodes that describe where
128 ASSERT_EXPRs for SSA name N_I should be inserted. */
129 static assert_locus **asserts_for;
131 /* Value range array. After propagation, VR_VALUE[I] holds the range
132 of values that SSA name N_I may take. */
133 static unsigned num_vr_values;
134 static value_range **vr_value;
135 static bool values_propagated;
137 /* For a PHI node which sets SSA name N_I, VR_COUNTS[I] holds the
138 number of executable edges we saw the last time we visited the
139 node. */
140 static int *vr_phi_edge_counts;
142 struct switch_update {
143 gswitch *stmt;
144 tree vec;
147 static vec<edge> to_remove_edges;
148 static vec<switch_update> to_update_switch_stmts;
151 /* Return the maximum value for TYPE. */
153 static inline tree
154 vrp_val_max (const_tree type)
156 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
157 return NULL_TREE;
159 return TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
162 /* Return the minimum value for TYPE. */
164 static inline tree
165 vrp_val_min (const_tree type)
167 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
168 return NULL_TREE;
170 return TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
173 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the maximum value of its type. This
174 will be true for a positive overflow infinity. We can't do a
175 simple equality comparison with TYPE_MAX_VALUE because C typedefs
176 and Ada subtypes can produce types whose TYPE_MAX_VALUE is not ==
177 to the integer constant with the same value in the type. */
179 static inline bool
180 vrp_val_is_max (const_tree val)
182 tree type_max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val));
183 return (val == type_max
184 || (type_max != NULL_TREE
185 && operand_equal_p (val, type_max, 0)));
188 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the minimum value of its type. This
189 will be true for a negative overflow infinity. */
191 static inline bool
192 vrp_val_is_min (const_tree val)
194 tree type_min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val));
195 return (val == type_min
196 || (type_min != NULL_TREE
197 && operand_equal_p (val, type_min, 0)));
201 /* Return whether TYPE should use an overflow infinity distinct from
202 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. We use an overflow infinity value to
203 represent a signed overflow during VRP computations. An infinity
204 is distinct from a half-range, which will go from some number to
205 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. */
207 static inline bool
208 needs_overflow_infinity (const_tree type)
210 return INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type);
213 /* Return whether TYPE can support our overflow infinity
214 representation: we use the TREE_OVERFLOW flag, which only exists
215 for constants. If TYPE doesn't support this, we don't optimize
216 cases which would require signed overflow--we drop them to
217 VARYING. */
219 static inline bool
220 supports_overflow_infinity (const_tree type)
222 tree min = vrp_val_min (type), max = vrp_val_max (type);
223 gcc_checking_assert (needs_overflow_infinity (type));
224 return (min != NULL_TREE
225 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (min)
226 && max != NULL_TREE
227 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (max));
230 /* VAL is the maximum or minimum value of a type. Return a
231 corresponding overflow infinity. */
233 static inline tree
234 make_overflow_infinity (tree val)
236 gcc_checking_assert (val != NULL_TREE && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val));
237 val = copy_node (val);
238 TREE_OVERFLOW (val) = 1;
239 return val;
242 /* Return a negative overflow infinity for TYPE. */
244 static inline tree
245 negative_overflow_infinity (tree type)
247 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type));
248 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_min (type));
251 /* Return a positive overflow infinity for TYPE. */
253 static inline tree
254 positive_overflow_infinity (tree type)
256 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type));
257 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_max (type));
260 /* Return whether VAL is a negative overflow infinity. */
262 static inline bool
263 is_negative_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
265 return (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (val)
266 && needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
267 && vrp_val_is_min (val));
270 /* Return whether VAL is a positive overflow infinity. */
272 static inline bool
273 is_positive_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
275 return (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (val)
276 && needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
277 && vrp_val_is_max (val));
280 /* Return whether VAL is a positive or negative overflow infinity. */
282 static inline bool
283 is_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
285 return (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (val)
286 && needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
287 && (vrp_val_is_min (val) || vrp_val_is_max (val)));
290 /* Return whether STMT has a constant rhs that is_overflow_infinity. */
292 static inline bool
293 stmt_overflow_infinity (gimple *stmt)
295 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
296 && get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt)) ==
297 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS)
298 return is_overflow_infinity (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
299 return false;
302 /* If VAL is now an overflow infinity, return VAL. Otherwise, return
303 the same value with TREE_OVERFLOW clear. This can be used to avoid
304 confusing a regular value with an overflow value. */
306 static inline tree
307 avoid_overflow_infinity (tree val)
309 if (!is_overflow_infinity (val))
310 return val;
312 if (vrp_val_is_max (val))
313 return vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val));
314 else
316 gcc_checking_assert (vrp_val_is_min (val));
317 return vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val));
322 /* Set value range VR to VR_UNDEFINED. */
324 static inline void
325 set_value_range_to_undefined (value_range *vr)
327 vr->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
328 vr->min = vr->max = NULL_TREE;
329 if (vr->equiv)
330 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
334 /* Set value range VR to VR_VARYING. */
336 static inline void
337 set_value_range_to_varying (value_range *vr)
339 vr->type = VR_VARYING;
340 vr->min = vr->max = NULL_TREE;
341 if (vr->equiv)
342 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
346 /* Set value range VR to {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}. */
348 static void
349 set_value_range (value_range *vr, enum value_range_type t, tree min,
350 tree max, bitmap equiv)
352 /* Check the validity of the range. */
353 if (flag_checking
354 && (t == VR_RANGE || t == VR_ANTI_RANGE))
356 int cmp;
358 gcc_assert (min && max);
360 gcc_assert ((!TREE_OVERFLOW_P (min) || is_overflow_infinity (min))
361 && (!TREE_OVERFLOW_P (max) || is_overflow_infinity (max)));
363 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min)) && t == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
364 gcc_assert (!vrp_val_is_min (min) || !vrp_val_is_max (max));
366 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
367 gcc_assert (cmp == 0 || cmp == -1 || cmp == -2);
370 if (flag_checking
371 && (t == VR_UNDEFINED || t == VR_VARYING))
373 gcc_assert (min == NULL_TREE && max == NULL_TREE);
374 gcc_assert (equiv == NULL || bitmap_empty_p (equiv));
377 vr->type = t;
378 vr->min = min;
379 vr->max = max;
381 /* Since updating the equivalence set involves deep copying the
382 bitmaps, only do it if absolutely necessary. */
383 if (vr->equiv == NULL
384 && equiv != NULL)
385 vr->equiv = BITMAP_ALLOC (&vrp_equiv_obstack);
387 if (equiv != vr->equiv)
389 if (equiv && !bitmap_empty_p (equiv))
390 bitmap_copy (vr->equiv, equiv);
391 else
392 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
397 /* Set value range VR to the canonical form of {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}.
398 This means adjusting T, MIN and MAX representing the case of a
399 wrapping range with MAX < MIN covering [MIN, type_max] U [type_min, MAX]
400 as anti-rage ~[MAX+1, MIN-1]. Likewise for wrapping anti-ranges.
401 In corner cases where MAX+1 or MIN-1 wraps this will fall back
402 to varying.
403 This routine exists to ease canonicalization in the case where we
404 extract ranges from var + CST op limit. */
406 static void
407 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (value_range *vr, enum value_range_type t,
408 tree min, tree max, bitmap equiv)
410 /* Use the canonical setters for VR_UNDEFINED and VR_VARYING. */
411 if (t == VR_UNDEFINED)
413 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
414 return;
416 else if (t == VR_VARYING)
418 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
419 return;
422 /* Nothing to canonicalize for symbolic ranges. */
423 if (TREE_CODE (min) != INTEGER_CST
424 || TREE_CODE (max) != INTEGER_CST)
426 set_value_range (vr, t, min, max, equiv);
427 return;
430 /* Wrong order for min and max, to swap them and the VR type we need
431 to adjust them. */
432 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max, min))
434 tree one, tmp;
436 /* For one bit precision if max < min, then the swapped
437 range covers all values, so for VR_RANGE it is varying and
438 for VR_ANTI_RANGE empty range, so drop to varying as well. */
439 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1)
441 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
442 return;
445 one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1);
446 tmp = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, max, one);
447 max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, min, one);
448 min = tmp;
450 /* There's one corner case, if we had [C+1, C] before we now have
451 that again. But this represents an empty value range, so drop
452 to varying in this case. */
453 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max, min))
455 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
456 return;
459 t = t == VR_RANGE ? VR_ANTI_RANGE : VR_RANGE;
462 /* Anti-ranges that can be represented as ranges should be so. */
463 if (t == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
465 bool is_min = vrp_val_is_min (min);
466 bool is_max = vrp_val_is_max (max);
468 if (is_min && is_max)
470 /* We cannot deal with empty ranges, drop to varying.
471 ??? This could be VR_UNDEFINED instead. */
472 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
473 return;
475 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1
476 && (is_min || is_max))
478 /* Non-empty boolean ranges can always be represented
479 as a singleton range. */
480 if (is_min)
481 min = max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (min));
482 else
483 min = max = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min));
484 t = VR_RANGE;
486 else if (is_min
487 /* As a special exception preserve non-null ranges. */
488 && !(TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min))
489 && integer_zerop (max)))
491 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), 1);
492 min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, max, one);
493 max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (max));
494 t = VR_RANGE;
496 else if (is_max)
498 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1);
499 max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, min, one);
500 min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min));
501 t = VR_RANGE;
505 /* Do not drop [-INF(OVF), +INF(OVF)] to varying. (OVF) has to be sticky
506 to make sure VRP iteration terminates, otherwise we can get into
507 oscillations. */
509 set_value_range (vr, t, min, max, equiv);
512 /* Copy value range FROM into value range TO. */
514 static inline void
515 copy_value_range (value_range *to, value_range *from)
517 set_value_range (to, from->type, from->min, from->max, from->equiv);
520 /* Set value range VR to a single value. This function is only called
521 with values we get from statements, and exists to clear the
522 TREE_OVERFLOW flag so that we don't think we have an overflow
523 infinity when we shouldn't. */
525 static inline void
526 set_value_range_to_value (value_range *vr, tree val, bitmap equiv)
528 gcc_assert (is_gimple_min_invariant (val));
529 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (val))
530 val = drop_tree_overflow (val);
531 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, val, val, equiv);
534 /* Set value range VR to a non-negative range of type TYPE.
535 OVERFLOW_INFINITY indicates whether to use an overflow infinity
536 rather than TYPE_MAX_VALUE; this should be true if we determine
537 that the range is nonnegative based on the assumption that signed
538 overflow does not occur. */
540 static inline void
541 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (value_range *vr, tree type,
542 bool overflow_infinity)
544 tree zero;
546 if (overflow_infinity && !supports_overflow_infinity (type))
548 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
549 return;
552 zero = build_int_cst (type, 0);
553 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, zero,
554 (overflow_infinity
555 ? positive_overflow_infinity (type)
556 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type)),
557 vr->equiv);
560 /* Set value range VR to a non-NULL range of type TYPE. */
562 static inline void
563 set_value_range_to_nonnull (value_range *vr, tree type)
565 tree zero = build_int_cst (type, 0);
566 set_value_range (vr, VR_ANTI_RANGE, zero, zero, vr->equiv);
570 /* Set value range VR to a NULL range of type TYPE. */
572 static inline void
573 set_value_range_to_null (value_range *vr, tree type)
575 set_value_range_to_value (vr, build_int_cst (type, 0), vr->equiv);
579 /* Set value range VR to a range of a truthvalue of type TYPE. */
581 static inline void
582 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (value_range *vr, tree type)
584 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1)
585 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
586 else
587 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE,
588 build_int_cst (type, 0), build_int_cst (type, 1),
589 vr->equiv);
593 /* If abs (min) < abs (max), set VR to [-max, max], if
594 abs (min) >= abs (max), set VR to [-min, min]. */
596 static void
597 abs_extent_range (value_range *vr, tree min, tree max)
599 int cmp;
601 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (min) == INTEGER_CST);
602 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (max) == INTEGER_CST);
603 gcc_assert (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min)));
604 gcc_assert (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min)));
605 min = fold_unary (ABS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min);
606 max = fold_unary (ABS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max);
607 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) || TREE_OVERFLOW (max))
609 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
610 return;
612 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
613 if (cmp == -1)
614 min = fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), max);
615 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == 1)
617 max = min;
618 min = fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min);
620 else
622 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
623 return;
625 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, NULL);
629 /* Return value range information for VAR.
631 If we have no values ranges recorded (ie, VRP is not running), then
632 return NULL. Otherwise create an empty range if none existed for VAR. */
634 static value_range *
635 get_value_range (const_tree var)
637 static const value_range vr_const_varying
638 = { VR_VARYING, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE, NULL };
639 value_range *vr;
640 tree sym;
641 unsigned ver = SSA_NAME_VERSION (var);
643 /* If we have no recorded ranges, then return NULL. */
644 if (! vr_value)
645 return NULL;
647 /* If we query the range for a new SSA name return an unmodifiable VARYING.
648 We should get here at most from the substitute-and-fold stage which
649 will never try to change values. */
650 if (ver >= num_vr_values)
651 return CONST_CAST (value_range *, &vr_const_varying);
653 vr = vr_value[ver];
654 if (vr)
655 return vr;
657 /* After propagation finished do not allocate new value-ranges. */
658 if (values_propagated)
659 return CONST_CAST (value_range *, &vr_const_varying);
661 /* Create a default value range. */
662 vr_value[ver] = vr = vrp_value_range_pool.allocate ();
663 memset (vr, 0, sizeof (*vr));
665 /* Defer allocating the equivalence set. */
666 vr->equiv = NULL;
668 /* If VAR is a default definition of a parameter, the variable can
669 take any value in VAR's type. */
670 if (SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (var))
672 sym = SSA_NAME_VAR (var);
673 if (TREE_CODE (sym) == PARM_DECL)
675 /* Try to use the "nonnull" attribute to create ~[0, 0]
676 anti-ranges for pointers. Note that this is only valid with
677 default definitions of PARM_DECLs. */
678 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (sym))
679 && (nonnull_arg_p (sym)
680 || get_ptr_nonnull (var)))
681 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, TREE_TYPE (sym));
682 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (sym)))
684 wide_int min, max;
685 value_range_type rtype = get_range_info (var, &min, &max);
686 if (rtype == VR_RANGE || rtype == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
687 set_value_range (vr, rtype,
688 wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (var), min),
689 wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (var), max),
690 NULL);
691 else
692 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
694 else
695 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
697 else if (TREE_CODE (sym) == RESULT_DECL
698 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (sym))
699 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, TREE_TYPE (sym));
702 return vr;
705 /* Set value-ranges of all SSA names defined by STMT to varying. */
707 static void
708 set_defs_to_varying (gimple *stmt)
710 ssa_op_iter i;
711 tree def;
712 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def, stmt, i, SSA_OP_DEF)
714 value_range *vr = get_value_range (def);
715 /* Avoid writing to vr_const_varying get_value_range may return. */
716 if (vr->type != VR_VARYING)
717 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
722 /* Return true, if VAL1 and VAL2 are equal values for VRP purposes. */
724 static inline bool
725 vrp_operand_equal_p (const_tree val1, const_tree val2)
727 if (val1 == val2)
728 return true;
729 if (!val1 || !val2 || !operand_equal_p (val1, val2, 0))
730 return false;
731 return is_overflow_infinity (val1) == is_overflow_infinity (val2);
734 /* Return true, if the bitmaps B1 and B2 are equal. */
736 static inline bool
737 vrp_bitmap_equal_p (const_bitmap b1, const_bitmap b2)
739 return (b1 == b2
740 || ((!b1 || bitmap_empty_p (b1))
741 && (!b2 || bitmap_empty_p (b2)))
742 || (b1 && b2
743 && bitmap_equal_p (b1, b2)));
746 /* Update the value range and equivalence set for variable VAR to
747 NEW_VR. Return true if NEW_VR is different from VAR's previous
748 value.
750 NOTE: This function assumes that NEW_VR is a temporary value range
751 object created for the sole purpose of updating VAR's range. The
752 storage used by the equivalence set from NEW_VR will be freed by
753 this function. Do not call update_value_range when NEW_VR
754 is the range object associated with another SSA name. */
756 static inline bool
757 update_value_range (const_tree var, value_range *new_vr)
759 value_range *old_vr;
760 bool is_new;
762 /* If there is a value-range on the SSA name from earlier analysis
763 factor that in. */
764 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (var)))
766 wide_int min, max;
767 value_range_type rtype = get_range_info (var, &min, &max);
768 if (rtype == VR_RANGE || rtype == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
770 tree nr_min, nr_max;
771 /* Range info on SSA names doesn't carry overflow information
772 so make sure to preserve the overflow bit on the lattice. */
773 if (rtype == VR_RANGE
774 && needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (var))
775 && (new_vr->type == VR_VARYING
776 || (new_vr->type == VR_RANGE
777 && is_negative_overflow_infinity (new_vr->min)))
778 && wi::eq_p (vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (var)), min))
779 nr_min = negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (var));
780 else
781 nr_min = wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (var), min);
782 if (rtype == VR_RANGE
783 && needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (var))
784 && (new_vr->type == VR_VARYING
785 || (new_vr->type == VR_RANGE
786 && is_positive_overflow_infinity (new_vr->max)))
787 && wi::eq_p (vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (var)), max))
788 nr_max = positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (var));
789 else
790 nr_max = wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (var), max);
791 value_range nr = VR_INITIALIZER;
792 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (&nr, rtype, nr_min, nr_max, NULL);
793 vrp_intersect_ranges (new_vr, &nr);
797 /* Update the value range, if necessary. */
798 old_vr = get_value_range (var);
799 is_new = old_vr->type != new_vr->type
800 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->min, new_vr->min)
801 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->max, new_vr->max)
802 || !vrp_bitmap_equal_p (old_vr->equiv, new_vr->equiv);
804 if (is_new)
806 /* Do not allow transitions up the lattice. The following
807 is slightly more awkward than just new_vr->type < old_vr->type
808 because VR_RANGE and VR_ANTI_RANGE need to be considered
809 the same. We may not have is_new when transitioning to
810 UNDEFINED. If old_vr->type is VARYING, we shouldn't be
811 called. */
812 if (new_vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
814 BITMAP_FREE (new_vr->equiv);
815 set_value_range_to_varying (old_vr);
816 set_value_range_to_varying (new_vr);
817 return true;
819 else
820 set_value_range (old_vr, new_vr->type, new_vr->min, new_vr->max,
821 new_vr->equiv);
824 BITMAP_FREE (new_vr->equiv);
826 return is_new;
830 /* Add VAR and VAR's equivalence set to EQUIV. This is the central
831 point where equivalence processing can be turned on/off. */
833 static void
834 add_equivalence (bitmap *equiv, const_tree var)
836 unsigned ver = SSA_NAME_VERSION (var);
837 value_range *vr = get_value_range (var);
839 if (*equiv == NULL)
840 *equiv = BITMAP_ALLOC (&vrp_equiv_obstack);
841 bitmap_set_bit (*equiv, ver);
842 if (vr && vr->equiv)
843 bitmap_ior_into (*equiv, vr->equiv);
847 /* Return true if VR is ~[0, 0]. */
849 static inline bool
850 range_is_nonnull (value_range *vr)
852 return vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
853 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
854 && integer_zerop (vr->max);
858 /* Return true if VR is [0, 0]. */
860 static inline bool
861 range_is_null (value_range *vr)
863 return vr->type == VR_RANGE
864 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
865 && integer_zerop (vr->max);
868 /* Return true if max and min of VR are INTEGER_CST. It's not necessary
869 a singleton. */
871 static inline bool
872 range_int_cst_p (value_range *vr)
874 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
875 && TREE_CODE (vr->max) == INTEGER_CST
876 && TREE_CODE (vr->min) == INTEGER_CST);
879 /* Return true if VR is a INTEGER_CST singleton. */
881 static inline bool
882 range_int_cst_singleton_p (value_range *vr)
884 return (range_int_cst_p (vr)
885 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
886 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr->max)
887 && tree_int_cst_equal (vr->min, vr->max));
890 /* Return true if value range VR involves at least one symbol. */
892 static inline bool
893 symbolic_range_p (value_range *vr)
895 return (!is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min)
896 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->max));
899 /* Return the single symbol (an SSA_NAME) contained in T if any, or NULL_TREE
900 otherwise. We only handle additive operations and set NEG to true if the
901 symbol is negated and INV to the invariant part, if any. */
903 static tree
904 get_single_symbol (tree t, bool *neg, tree *inv)
906 bool neg_;
907 tree inv_;
909 *inv = NULL_TREE;
910 *neg = false;
912 if (TREE_CODE (t) == PLUS_EXPR
913 || TREE_CODE (t) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
914 || TREE_CODE (t) == MINUS_EXPR)
916 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0)))
918 neg_ = (TREE_CODE (t) == MINUS_EXPR);
919 inv_ = TREE_OPERAND (t, 0);
920 t = TREE_OPERAND (t, 1);
922 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (TREE_OPERAND (t, 1)))
924 neg_ = false;
925 inv_ = TREE_OPERAND (t, 1);
926 t = TREE_OPERAND (t, 0);
928 else
929 return NULL_TREE;
931 else
933 neg_ = false;
934 inv_ = NULL_TREE;
937 if (TREE_CODE (t) == NEGATE_EXPR)
939 t = TREE_OPERAND (t, 0);
940 neg_ = !neg_;
943 if (TREE_CODE (t) != SSA_NAME)
944 return NULL_TREE;
946 *neg = neg_;
947 *inv = inv_;
948 return t;
951 /* The reverse operation: build a symbolic expression with TYPE
952 from symbol SYM, negated according to NEG, and invariant INV. */
954 static tree
955 build_symbolic_expr (tree type, tree sym, bool neg, tree inv)
957 const bool pointer_p = POINTER_TYPE_P (type);
958 tree t = sym;
960 if (neg)
961 t = build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, type, t);
963 if (integer_zerop (inv))
964 return t;
966 return build2 (pointer_p ? POINTER_PLUS_EXPR : PLUS_EXPR, type, t, inv);
969 /* Return true if value range VR involves exactly one symbol SYM. */
971 static bool
972 symbolic_range_based_on_p (value_range *vr, const_tree sym)
974 bool neg, min_has_symbol, max_has_symbol;
975 tree inv;
977 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min))
978 min_has_symbol = false;
979 else if (get_single_symbol (vr->min, &neg, &inv) == sym)
980 min_has_symbol = true;
981 else
982 return false;
984 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->max))
985 max_has_symbol = false;
986 else if (get_single_symbol (vr->max, &neg, &inv) == sym)
987 max_has_symbol = true;
988 else
989 return false;
991 return (min_has_symbol || max_has_symbol);
994 /* Return true if value range VR uses an overflow infinity. */
996 static inline bool
997 overflow_infinity_range_p (value_range *vr)
999 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
1000 && (is_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
1001 || is_overflow_infinity (vr->max)));
1004 /* Return false if we can not make a valid comparison based on VR;
1005 this will be the case if it uses an overflow infinity and overflow
1006 is not undefined (i.e., -fno-strict-overflow is in effect).
1007 Otherwise return true, and set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true if VR
1008 uses an overflow infinity. */
1010 static bool
1011 usable_range_p (value_range *vr, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1013 gcc_assert (vr->type == VR_RANGE);
1014 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr->min))
1016 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1017 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr->min)))
1018 return false;
1020 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
1022 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1023 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr->max)))
1024 return false;
1026 return true;
1029 /* Return true if the result of assignment STMT is know to be non-zero.
1030 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1031 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1032 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1034 static bool
1035 gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple *stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1037 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
1038 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (code))
1040 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
1041 return tree_unary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
1042 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
1043 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1044 strict_overflow_p);
1045 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
1046 return tree_binary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
1047 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
1048 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1049 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt),
1050 strict_overflow_p);
1051 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
1052 return false;
1053 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
1054 return tree_single_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1055 strict_overflow_p);
1056 case GIMPLE_INVALID_RHS:
1057 gcc_unreachable ();
1058 default:
1059 gcc_unreachable ();
1063 /* Return true if STMT is known to compute a non-zero value.
1064 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1065 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1066 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1068 static bool
1069 gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple *stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1071 switch (gimple_code (stmt))
1073 case GIMPLE_ASSIGN:
1074 return gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p);
1075 case GIMPLE_CALL:
1077 tree fndecl = gimple_call_fndecl (stmt);
1078 if (!fndecl) return false;
1079 if (flag_delete_null_pointer_checks && !flag_check_new
1080 && DECL_IS_OPERATOR_NEW (fndecl)
1081 && !TREE_NOTHROW (fndecl))
1082 return true;
1083 /* References are always non-NULL. */
1084 if (flag_delete_null_pointer_checks
1085 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) == REFERENCE_TYPE)
1086 return true;
1087 if (flag_delete_null_pointer_checks &&
1088 lookup_attribute ("returns_nonnull",
1089 TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (gimple_call_fntype (stmt))))
1090 return true;
1092 gcall *call_stmt = as_a<gcall *> (stmt);
1093 unsigned rf = gimple_call_return_flags (call_stmt);
1094 if (rf & ERF_RETURNS_ARG)
1096 unsigned argnum = rf & ERF_RETURN_ARG_MASK;
1097 if (argnum < gimple_call_num_args (call_stmt))
1099 tree arg = gimple_call_arg (call_stmt, argnum);
1100 if (SSA_VAR_P (arg)
1101 && infer_nonnull_range_by_attribute (stmt, arg))
1102 return true;
1105 return gimple_alloca_call_p (stmt);
1107 default:
1108 gcc_unreachable ();
1112 /* Like tree_expr_nonzero_warnv_p, but this function uses value ranges
1113 obtained so far. */
1115 static bool
1116 vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (gimple *stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1118 if (gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p))
1119 return true;
1121 /* If we have an expression of the form &X->a, then the expression
1122 is nonnull if X is nonnull. */
1123 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
1124 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == ADDR_EXPR)
1126 tree expr = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
1127 tree base = get_base_address (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0));
1129 if (base != NULL_TREE
1130 && TREE_CODE (base) == MEM_REF
1131 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (base, 0)) == SSA_NAME)
1133 value_range *vr = get_value_range (TREE_OPERAND (base, 0));
1134 if (range_is_nonnull (vr))
1135 return true;
1139 return false;
1142 /* Returns true if EXPR is a valid value (as expected by compare_values) --
1143 a gimple invariant, or SSA_NAME +- CST. */
1145 static bool
1146 valid_value_p (tree expr)
1148 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == SSA_NAME)
1149 return true;
1151 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == PLUS_EXPR
1152 || TREE_CODE (expr) == MINUS_EXPR)
1153 return (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0)) == SSA_NAME
1154 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 1)) == INTEGER_CST);
1156 return is_gimple_min_invariant (expr);
1159 /* Return
1160 1 if VAL < VAL2
1161 0 if !(VAL < VAL2)
1162 -2 if those are incomparable. */
1163 static inline int
1164 operand_less_p (tree val, tree val2)
1166 /* LT is folded faster than GE and others. Inline the common case. */
1167 if (TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST && TREE_CODE (val2) == INTEGER_CST)
1169 if (! is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2))
1170 return tree_int_cst_lt (val, val2);
1172 else
1174 tree tcmp;
1176 fold_defer_overflow_warnings ();
1178 tcmp = fold_binary_to_constant (LT_EXPR, boolean_type_node, val, val2);
1180 fold_undefer_and_ignore_overflow_warnings ();
1182 if (!tcmp
1183 || TREE_CODE (tcmp) != INTEGER_CST)
1184 return -2;
1186 if (!integer_zerop (tcmp))
1187 return 1;
1190 /* val >= val2, not considering overflow infinity. */
1191 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val))
1192 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : 1;
1193 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2))
1194 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val) ? 0 : 1;
1196 return 0;
1199 /* Compare two values VAL1 and VAL2. Return
1201 -2 if VAL1 and VAL2 cannot be compared at compile-time,
1202 -1 if VAL1 < VAL2,
1203 0 if VAL1 == VAL2,
1204 +1 if VAL1 > VAL2, and
1205 +2 if VAL1 != VAL2
1207 This is similar to tree_int_cst_compare but supports pointer values
1208 and values that cannot be compared at compile time.
1210 If STRICT_OVERFLOW_P is not NULL, then set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to
1211 true if the return value is only valid if we assume that signed
1212 overflow is undefined. */
1214 static int
1215 compare_values_warnv (tree val1, tree val2, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1217 if (val1 == val2)
1218 return 0;
1220 /* Below we rely on the fact that VAL1 and VAL2 are both pointers or
1221 both integers. */
1222 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1))
1223 == POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val2)));
1225 /* Convert the two values into the same type. This is needed because
1226 sizetype causes sign extension even for unsigned types. */
1227 val2 = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (val1), val2);
1228 STRIP_USELESS_TYPE_CONVERSION (val2);
1230 const bool overflow_undefined
1231 = INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1))
1232 && TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (val1));
1233 tree inv1, inv2;
1234 bool neg1, neg2;
1235 tree sym1 = get_single_symbol (val1, &neg1, &inv1);
1236 tree sym2 = get_single_symbol (val2, &neg2, &inv2);
1238 /* If VAL1 and VAL2 are of the form '[-]NAME [+ CST]', return -1 or +1
1239 accordingly. If VAL1 and VAL2 don't use the same name, return -2. */
1240 if (sym1 && sym2)
1242 /* Both values must use the same name with the same sign. */
1243 if (sym1 != sym2 || neg1 != neg2)
1244 return -2;
1246 /* [-]NAME + CST == [-]NAME + CST. */
1247 if (inv1 == inv2)
1248 return 0;
1250 /* If overflow is defined we cannot simplify more. */
1251 if (!overflow_undefined)
1252 return -2;
1254 if (strict_overflow_p != NULL
1255 && (!inv1 || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val1))
1256 && (!inv2 || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val2)))
1257 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1259 if (!inv1)
1260 inv1 = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (val1), 0);
1261 if (!inv2)
1262 inv2 = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (val2), 0);
1264 return compare_values_warnv (inv1, inv2, strict_overflow_p);
1267 const bool cst1 = is_gimple_min_invariant (val1);
1268 const bool cst2 = is_gimple_min_invariant (val2);
1270 /* If one is of the form '[-]NAME + CST' and the other is constant, then
1271 it might be possible to say something depending on the constants. */
1272 if ((sym1 && inv1 && cst2) || (sym2 && inv2 && cst1))
1274 if (!overflow_undefined)
1275 return -2;
1277 if (strict_overflow_p != NULL
1278 && (!sym1 || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val1))
1279 && (!sym2 || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val2)))
1280 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1282 const signop sgn = TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (val1));
1283 tree cst = cst1 ? val1 : val2;
1284 tree inv = cst1 ? inv2 : inv1;
1286 /* Compute the difference between the constants. If it overflows or
1287 underflows, this means that we can trivially compare the NAME with
1288 it and, consequently, the two values with each other. */
1289 wide_int diff = wi::sub (cst, inv);
1290 if (wi::cmp (0, inv, sgn) != wi::cmp (diff, cst, sgn))
1292 const int res = wi::cmp (cst, inv, sgn);
1293 return cst1 ? res : -res;
1296 return -2;
1299 /* We cannot say anything more for non-constants. */
1300 if (!cst1 || !cst2)
1301 return -2;
1303 if (!POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1305 /* We cannot compare overflowed values, except for overflow
1306 infinities. */
1307 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (val1) || TREE_OVERFLOW (val2))
1309 if (strict_overflow_p != NULL)
1310 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1311 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val1))
1312 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : -1;
1313 else if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2))
1314 return 1;
1315 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val1))
1316 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : 1;
1317 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2))
1318 return -1;
1319 return -2;
1322 return tree_int_cst_compare (val1, val2);
1324 else
1326 tree t;
1328 /* First see if VAL1 and VAL2 are not the same. */
1329 if (val1 == val2 || operand_equal_p (val1, val2, 0))
1330 return 0;
1332 /* If VAL1 is a lower address than VAL2, return -1. */
1333 if (operand_less_p (val1, val2) == 1)
1334 return -1;
1336 /* If VAL1 is a higher address than VAL2, return +1. */
1337 if (operand_less_p (val2, val1) == 1)
1338 return 1;
1340 /* If VAL1 is different than VAL2, return +2.
1341 For integer constants we either have already returned -1 or 1
1342 or they are equivalent. We still might succeed in proving
1343 something about non-trivial operands. */
1344 if (TREE_CODE (val1) != INTEGER_CST
1345 || TREE_CODE (val2) != INTEGER_CST)
1347 t = fold_binary_to_constant (NE_EXPR, boolean_type_node, val1, val2);
1348 if (t && integer_onep (t))
1349 return 2;
1352 return -2;
1356 /* Compare values like compare_values_warnv, but treat comparisons of
1357 nonconstants which rely on undefined overflow as incomparable. */
1359 static int
1360 compare_values (tree val1, tree val2)
1362 bool sop;
1363 int ret;
1365 sop = false;
1366 ret = compare_values_warnv (val1, val2, &sop);
1367 if (sop
1368 && (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val1) || !is_gimple_min_invariant (val2)))
1369 ret = -2;
1370 return ret;
1374 /* Return 1 if VAL is inside value range MIN <= VAL <= MAX,
1375 0 if VAL is not inside [MIN, MAX],
1376 -2 if we cannot tell either way.
1378 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1379 function. */
1381 static inline int
1382 value_inside_range (tree val, tree min, tree max)
1384 int cmp1, cmp2;
1386 cmp1 = operand_less_p (val, min);
1387 if (cmp1 == -2)
1388 return -2;
1389 if (cmp1 == 1)
1390 return 0;
1392 cmp2 = operand_less_p (max, val);
1393 if (cmp2 == -2)
1394 return -2;
1396 return !cmp2;
1400 /* Return true if value ranges VR0 and VR1 have a non-empty
1401 intersection.
1403 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1404 function.
1407 static inline bool
1408 value_ranges_intersect_p (value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1)
1410 /* The value ranges do not intersect if the maximum of the first range is
1411 less than the minimum of the second range or vice versa.
1412 When those relations are unknown, we can't do any better. */
1413 if (operand_less_p (vr0->max, vr1->min) != 0)
1414 return false;
1415 if (operand_less_p (vr1->max, vr0->min) != 0)
1416 return false;
1417 return true;
1421 /* Return 1 if [MIN, MAX] includes the value zero, 0 if it does not
1422 include the value zero, -2 if we cannot tell. */
1424 static inline int
1425 range_includes_zero_p (tree min, tree max)
1427 tree zero = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 0);
1428 return value_inside_range (zero, min, max);
1431 /* Return true if *VR is know to only contain nonnegative values. */
1433 static inline bool
1434 value_range_nonnegative_p (value_range *vr)
1436 /* Testing for VR_ANTI_RANGE is not useful here as any anti-range
1437 which would return a useful value should be encoded as a
1438 VR_RANGE. */
1439 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
1441 int result = compare_values (vr->min, integer_zero_node);
1442 return (result == 0 || result == 1);
1445 return false;
1448 /* If *VR has a value rante that is a single constant value return that,
1449 otherwise return NULL_TREE. */
1451 static tree
1452 value_range_constant_singleton (value_range *vr)
1454 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
1455 && vrp_operand_equal_p (vr->min, vr->max)
1456 && is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min))
1457 return vr->min;
1459 return NULL_TREE;
1462 /* If OP has a value range with a single constant value return that,
1463 otherwise return NULL_TREE. This returns OP itself if OP is a
1464 constant. */
1466 static tree
1467 op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (tree op)
1469 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op))
1470 return op;
1472 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
1473 return NULL_TREE;
1475 return value_range_constant_singleton (get_value_range (op));
1478 /* Return true if op is in a boolean [0, 1] value-range. */
1480 static bool
1481 op_with_boolean_value_range_p (tree op)
1483 value_range *vr;
1485 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op)) == 1)
1486 return true;
1488 if (integer_zerop (op)
1489 || integer_onep (op))
1490 return true;
1492 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
1493 return false;
1495 vr = get_value_range (op);
1496 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
1497 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
1498 && integer_onep (vr->max));
1501 /* Extract value range information for VAR when (OP COND_CODE LIMIT) is
1502 true and store it in *VR_P. */
1504 static void
1505 extract_range_for_var_from_comparison_expr (tree var, enum tree_code cond_code,
1506 tree op, tree limit,
1507 value_range *vr_p)
1509 tree min, max, type;
1510 value_range *limit_vr;
1511 limit = avoid_overflow_infinity (limit);
1512 type = TREE_TYPE (var);
1513 gcc_assert (limit != var);
1515 /* For pointer arithmetic, we only keep track of pointer equality
1516 and inequality. */
1517 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) && cond_code != NE_EXPR && cond_code != EQ_EXPR)
1519 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1520 return;
1523 /* If LIMIT is another SSA name and LIMIT has a range of its own,
1524 try to use LIMIT's range to avoid creating symbolic ranges
1525 unnecessarily. */
1526 limit_vr = (TREE_CODE (limit) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (limit) : NULL;
1528 /* LIMIT's range is only interesting if it has any useful information. */
1529 if (! limit_vr
1530 || limit_vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED
1531 || limit_vr->type == VR_VARYING
1532 || (symbolic_range_p (limit_vr)
1533 && ! (limit_vr->type == VR_RANGE
1534 && (limit_vr->min == limit_vr->max
1535 || operand_equal_p (limit_vr->min, limit_vr->max, 0)))))
1536 limit_vr = NULL;
1538 /* Initially, the new range has the same set of equivalences of
1539 VAR's range. This will be revised before returning the final
1540 value. Since assertions may be chained via mutually exclusive
1541 predicates, we will need to trim the set of equivalences before
1542 we are done. */
1543 gcc_assert (vr_p->equiv == NULL);
1544 add_equivalence (&vr_p->equiv, var);
1546 /* Extract a new range based on the asserted comparison for VAR and
1547 LIMIT's value range. Notice that if LIMIT has an anti-range, we
1548 will only use it for equality comparisons (EQ_EXPR). For any
1549 other kind of assertion, we cannot derive a range from LIMIT's
1550 anti-range that can be used to describe the new range. For
1551 instance, ASSERT_EXPR <x_2, x_2 <= b_4>. If b_4 is ~[2, 10],
1552 then b_4 takes on the ranges [-INF, 1] and [11, +INF]. There is
1553 no single range for x_2 that could describe LE_EXPR, so we might
1554 as well build the range [b_4, +INF] for it.
1555 One special case we handle is extracting a range from a
1556 range test encoded as (unsigned)var + CST <= limit. */
1557 if (TREE_CODE (op) == NOP_EXPR
1558 || TREE_CODE (op) == PLUS_EXPR)
1560 if (TREE_CODE (op) == PLUS_EXPR)
1562 min = fold_build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (op, 1)),
1563 TREE_OPERAND (op, 1));
1564 max = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, limit, min);
1565 op = TREE_OPERAND (op, 0);
1567 else
1569 min = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (var), 0);
1570 max = limit;
1573 /* Make sure to not set TREE_OVERFLOW on the final type
1574 conversion. We are willingly interpreting large positive
1575 unsigned values as negative signed values here. */
1576 min = force_fit_type (TREE_TYPE (var), wi::to_widest (min), 0, false);
1577 max = force_fit_type (TREE_TYPE (var), wi::to_widest (max), 0, false);
1579 /* We can transform a max, min range to an anti-range or
1580 vice-versa. Use set_and_canonicalize_value_range which does
1581 this for us. */
1582 if (cond_code == LE_EXPR)
1583 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE,
1584 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1585 else if (cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1586 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_ANTI_RANGE,
1587 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1588 else
1589 gcc_unreachable ();
1591 else if (cond_code == EQ_EXPR)
1593 enum value_range_type range_type;
1595 if (limit_vr)
1597 range_type = limit_vr->type;
1598 min = limit_vr->min;
1599 max = limit_vr->max;
1601 else
1603 range_type = VR_RANGE;
1604 min = limit;
1605 max = limit;
1608 set_value_range (vr_p, range_type, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1610 /* When asserting the equality VAR == LIMIT and LIMIT is another
1611 SSA name, the new range will also inherit the equivalence set
1612 from LIMIT. */
1613 if (TREE_CODE (limit) == SSA_NAME)
1614 add_equivalence (&vr_p->equiv, limit);
1616 else if (cond_code == NE_EXPR)
1618 /* As described above, when LIMIT's range is an anti-range and
1619 this assertion is an inequality (NE_EXPR), then we cannot
1620 derive anything from the anti-range. For instance, if
1621 LIMIT's range was ~[0, 0], the assertion 'VAR != LIMIT' does
1622 not imply that VAR's range is [0, 0]. So, in the case of
1623 anti-ranges, we just assert the inequality using LIMIT and
1624 not its anti-range.
1626 If LIMIT_VR is a range, we can only use it to build a new
1627 anti-range if LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range. For
1628 instance, if LIMIT_VR is [0, 1], the predicate
1629 VAR != [0, 1] does not mean that VAR's range is ~[0, 1].
1630 Rather, it means that for value 0 VAR should be ~[0, 0]
1631 and for value 1, VAR should be ~[1, 1]. We cannot
1632 represent these ranges.
1634 The only situation in which we can build a valid
1635 anti-range is when LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range
1636 (i.e., LIMIT_VR->MIN == LIMIT_VR->MAX). In that case,
1637 build the anti-range ~[LIMIT_VR->MIN, LIMIT_VR->MAX]. */
1638 if (limit_vr
1639 && limit_vr->type == VR_RANGE
1640 && compare_values (limit_vr->min, limit_vr->max) == 0)
1642 min = limit_vr->min;
1643 max = limit_vr->max;
1645 else
1647 /* In any other case, we cannot use LIMIT's range to build a
1648 valid anti-range. */
1649 min = max = limit;
1652 /* If MIN and MAX cover the whole range for their type, then
1653 just use the original LIMIT. */
1654 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
1655 && vrp_val_is_min (min)
1656 && vrp_val_is_max (max))
1657 min = max = limit;
1659 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_ANTI_RANGE,
1660 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1662 else if (cond_code == LE_EXPR || cond_code == LT_EXPR)
1664 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
1666 if (limit_vr == NULL || limit_vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
1667 max = limit;
1668 else
1670 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1671 range [MIN, N2] for LE_EXPR and [MIN, N2 - 1] for
1672 LT_EXPR. */
1673 max = limit_vr->max;
1676 /* If the maximum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1677 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1678 all should be optimized away above us. */
1679 if ((cond_code == LT_EXPR
1680 && compare_values (max, min) == 0)
1681 || is_overflow_infinity (max))
1682 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1683 else
1685 /* For LT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN, MAX - 1]. */
1686 if (cond_code == LT_EXPR)
1688 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (max)) == 1
1689 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (max)))
1690 max = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max,
1691 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), -1));
1692 else
1693 max = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max,
1694 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), 1));
1695 if (EXPR_P (max))
1696 TREE_NO_WARNING (max) = 1;
1699 set_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1702 else if (cond_code == GE_EXPR || cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1704 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
1706 if (limit_vr == NULL || limit_vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
1707 min = limit;
1708 else
1710 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1711 range [N1, MAX] for GE_EXPR and [N1 + 1, MAX] for
1712 GT_EXPR. */
1713 min = limit_vr->min;
1716 /* If the minimum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1717 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1718 all should be optimized away above us. */
1719 if ((cond_code == GT_EXPR
1720 && compare_values (min, max) == 0)
1721 || is_overflow_infinity (min))
1722 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1723 else
1725 /* For GT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN + 1, MAX]. */
1726 if (cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1728 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1
1729 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min)))
1730 min = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min,
1731 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), -1));
1732 else
1733 min = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min,
1734 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1));
1735 if (EXPR_P (min))
1736 TREE_NO_WARNING (min) = 1;
1739 set_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1742 else
1743 gcc_unreachable ();
1745 /* Finally intersect the new range with what we already know about var. */
1746 vrp_intersect_ranges (vr_p, get_value_range (var));
1749 /* Extract value range information from an ASSERT_EXPR EXPR and store
1750 it in *VR_P. */
1752 static void
1753 extract_range_from_assert (value_range *vr_p, tree expr)
1755 tree var = ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (expr);
1756 tree cond = ASSERT_EXPR_COND (expr);
1757 tree limit, op;
1758 enum tree_code cond_code;
1759 gcc_assert (COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond));
1761 /* Find VAR in the ASSERT_EXPR conditional. */
1762 if (var == TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)
1763 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
1764 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)) == NOP_EXPR)
1766 /* If the predicate is of the form VAR COMP LIMIT, then we just
1767 take LIMIT from the RHS and use the same comparison code. */
1768 cond_code = TREE_CODE (cond);
1769 limit = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1);
1770 op = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0);
1772 else
1774 /* If the predicate is of the form LIMIT COMP VAR, then we need
1775 to flip around the comparison code to create the proper range
1776 for VAR. */
1777 cond_code = swap_tree_comparison (TREE_CODE (cond));
1778 limit = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0);
1779 op = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1);
1781 extract_range_for_var_from_comparison_expr (var, cond_code, op,
1782 limit, vr_p);
1785 /* Extract range information from SSA name VAR and store it in VR. If
1786 VAR has an interesting range, use it. Otherwise, create the
1787 range [VAR, VAR] and return it. This is useful in situations where
1788 we may have conditionals testing values of VARYING names. For
1789 instance,
1791 x_3 = y_5;
1792 if (x_3 > y_5)
1795 Even if y_5 is deemed VARYING, we can determine that x_3 > y_5 is
1796 always false. */
1798 static void
1799 extract_range_from_ssa_name (value_range *vr, tree var)
1801 value_range *var_vr = get_value_range (var);
1803 if (var_vr->type != VR_VARYING)
1804 copy_value_range (vr, var_vr);
1805 else
1806 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, var, var, NULL);
1808 add_equivalence (&vr->equiv, var);
1812 /* Wrapper around int_const_binop. If the operation overflows and we
1813 are not using wrapping arithmetic, then adjust the result to be
1814 -INF or +INF depending on CODE, VAL1 and VAL2. This can return
1815 NULL_TREE if we need to use an overflow infinity representation but
1816 the type does not support it. */
1818 static tree
1819 vrp_int_const_binop (enum tree_code code, tree val1, tree val2)
1821 tree res;
1823 res = int_const_binop (code, val1, val2);
1825 /* If we are using unsigned arithmetic, operate symbolically
1826 on -INF and +INF as int_const_binop only handles signed overflow. */
1827 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1829 int checkz = compare_values (res, val1);
1830 bool overflow = false;
1832 /* Ensure that res = val1 [+*] val2 >= val1
1833 or that res = val1 - val2 <= val1. */
1834 if ((code == PLUS_EXPR
1835 && !(checkz == 1 || checkz == 0))
1836 || (code == MINUS_EXPR
1837 && !(checkz == 0 || checkz == -1)))
1839 overflow = true;
1841 /* Checking for multiplication overflow is done by dividing the
1842 output of the multiplication by the first input of the
1843 multiplication. If the result of that division operation is
1844 not equal to the second input of the multiplication, then the
1845 multiplication overflowed. */
1846 else if (code == MULT_EXPR && !integer_zerop (val1))
1848 tree tmp = int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
1849 res,
1850 val1);
1851 int check = compare_values (tmp, val2);
1853 if (check != 0)
1854 overflow = true;
1857 if (overflow)
1859 res = copy_node (res);
1860 TREE_OVERFLOW (res) = 1;
1864 else if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1865 /* If the singed operation wraps then int_const_binop has done
1866 everything we want. */
1868 /* Signed division of -1/0 overflows and by the time it gets here
1869 returns NULL_TREE. */
1870 else if (!res)
1871 return NULL_TREE;
1872 else if ((TREE_OVERFLOW (res)
1873 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val1)
1874 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val2))
1875 || is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1876 || is_overflow_infinity (val2))
1878 /* If the operation overflowed but neither VAL1 nor VAL2 are
1879 overflown, return -INF or +INF depending on the operation
1880 and the combination of signs of the operands. */
1881 int sgn1 = tree_int_cst_sgn (val1);
1882 int sgn2 = tree_int_cst_sgn (val2);
1884 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1885 && !supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res)))
1886 return NULL_TREE;
1888 /* We have to punt on adding infinities of different signs,
1889 since we can't tell what the sign of the result should be.
1890 Likewise for subtracting infinities of the same sign. */
1891 if (((code == PLUS_EXPR && sgn1 != sgn2)
1892 || (code == MINUS_EXPR && sgn1 == sgn2))
1893 && is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1894 && is_overflow_infinity (val2))
1895 return NULL_TREE;
1897 /* Don't try to handle division or shifting of infinities. */
1898 if ((code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1899 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1900 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1901 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1902 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR
1903 || code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
1904 && (is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1905 || is_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1906 return NULL_TREE;
1908 /* Notice that we only need to handle the restricted set of
1909 operations handled by extract_range_from_binary_expr.
1910 Among them, only multiplication, addition and subtraction
1911 can yield overflow without overflown operands because we
1912 are working with integral types only... except in the
1913 case VAL1 = -INF and VAL2 = -1 which overflows to +INF
1914 for division too. */
1916 /* For multiplication, the sign of the overflow is given
1917 by the comparison of the signs of the operands. */
1918 if ((code == MULT_EXPR && sgn1 == sgn2)
1919 /* For addition, the operands must be of the same sign
1920 to yield an overflow. Its sign is therefore that
1921 of one of the operands, for example the first. For
1922 infinite operands X + -INF is negative, not positive. */
1923 || (code == PLUS_EXPR
1924 && (sgn1 >= 0
1925 ? !is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2)
1926 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1927 /* For subtraction, non-infinite operands must be of
1928 different signs to yield an overflow. Its sign is
1929 therefore that of the first operand or the opposite of
1930 that of the second operand. A first operand of 0 counts
1931 as positive here, for the corner case 0 - (-INF), which
1932 overflows, but must yield +INF. For infinite operands 0
1933 - INF is negative, not positive. */
1934 || (code == MINUS_EXPR
1935 && (sgn1 >= 0
1936 ? !is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2)
1937 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1938 /* We only get in here with positive shift count, so the
1939 overflow direction is the same as the sign of val1.
1940 Actually rshift does not overflow at all, but we only
1941 handle the case of shifting overflowed -INF and +INF. */
1942 || (code == RSHIFT_EXPR
1943 && sgn1 >= 0)
1944 /* For division, the only case is -INF / -1 = +INF. */
1945 || code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1946 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1947 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1948 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1949 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR)
1950 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1951 ? positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1952 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res)));
1953 else
1954 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1955 ? negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1956 : TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res)));
1959 return res;
1963 /* For range VR compute two wide_int bitmasks. In *MAY_BE_NONZERO
1964 bitmask if some bit is unset, it means for all numbers in the range
1965 the bit is 0, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. In *MUST_BE_NONZERO
1966 bitmask if some bit is set, it means for all numbers in the range
1967 the bit is 1, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. */
1969 static bool
1970 zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (const tree expr_type,
1971 value_range *vr,
1972 wide_int *may_be_nonzero,
1973 wide_int *must_be_nonzero)
1975 *may_be_nonzero = wi::minus_one (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type));
1976 *must_be_nonzero = wi::zero (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type));
1977 if (!range_int_cst_p (vr)
1978 || is_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
1979 || is_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
1980 return false;
1982 if (range_int_cst_singleton_p (vr))
1984 *may_be_nonzero = vr->min;
1985 *must_be_nonzero = *may_be_nonzero;
1987 else if (tree_int_cst_sgn (vr->min) >= 0
1988 || tree_int_cst_sgn (vr->max) < 0)
1990 wide_int xor_mask = wi::bit_xor (vr->min, vr->max);
1991 *may_be_nonzero = wi::bit_or (vr->min, vr->max);
1992 *must_be_nonzero = wi::bit_and (vr->min, vr->max);
1993 if (xor_mask != 0)
1995 wide_int mask = wi::mask (wi::floor_log2 (xor_mask), false,
1996 may_be_nonzero->get_precision ());
1997 *may_be_nonzero = *may_be_nonzero | mask;
1998 *must_be_nonzero = must_be_nonzero->and_not (mask);
2002 return true;
2005 /* Create two value-ranges in *VR0 and *VR1 from the anti-range *AR
2006 so that *VR0 U *VR1 == *AR. Returns true if that is possible,
2007 false otherwise. If *AR can be represented with a single range
2008 *VR1 will be VR_UNDEFINED. */
2010 static bool
2011 ranges_from_anti_range (value_range *ar,
2012 value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1)
2014 tree type = TREE_TYPE (ar->min);
2016 vr0->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2017 vr1->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2019 if (ar->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE
2020 || TREE_CODE (ar->min) != INTEGER_CST
2021 || TREE_CODE (ar->max) != INTEGER_CST
2022 || !vrp_val_min (type)
2023 || !vrp_val_max (type))
2024 return false;
2026 if (!vrp_val_is_min (ar->min))
2028 vr0->type = VR_RANGE;
2029 vr0->min = vrp_val_min (type);
2030 vr0->max = wide_int_to_tree (type, wi::sub (ar->min, 1));
2032 if (!vrp_val_is_max (ar->max))
2034 vr1->type = VR_RANGE;
2035 vr1->min = wide_int_to_tree (type, wi::add (ar->max, 1));
2036 vr1->max = vrp_val_max (type);
2038 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2040 *vr0 = *vr1;
2041 vr1->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2044 return vr0->type != VR_UNDEFINED;
2047 /* Helper to extract a value-range *VR for a multiplicative operation
2048 *VR0 CODE *VR1. */
2050 static void
2051 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (value_range *vr,
2052 enum tree_code code,
2053 value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1)
2055 enum value_range_type type;
2056 tree val[4];
2057 size_t i;
2058 tree min, max;
2059 bool sop;
2060 int cmp;
2062 /* Multiplications, divisions and shifts are a bit tricky to handle,
2063 depending on the mix of signs we have in the two ranges, we
2064 need to operate on different values to get the minimum and
2065 maximum values for the new range. One approach is to figure
2066 out all the variations of range combinations and do the
2067 operations.
2069 However, this involves several calls to compare_values and it
2070 is pretty convoluted. It's simpler to do the 4 operations
2071 (MIN0 OP MIN1, MIN0 OP MAX1, MAX0 OP MIN1 and MAX0 OP MAX0 OP
2072 MAX1) and then figure the smallest and largest values to form
2073 the new range. */
2074 gcc_assert (code == MULT_EXPR
2075 || code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2076 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2077 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2078 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2079 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2080 || code == RSHIFT_EXPR
2081 || code == LSHIFT_EXPR);
2082 gcc_assert ((vr0->type == VR_RANGE
2083 || (code == MULT_EXPR && vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE))
2084 && vr0->type == vr1->type);
2086 type = vr0->type;
2088 /* Compute the 4 cross operations. */
2089 sop = false;
2090 val[0] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->min, vr1->min);
2091 if (val[0] == NULL_TREE)
2092 sop = true;
2094 if (vr1->max == vr1->min)
2095 val[1] = NULL_TREE;
2096 else
2098 val[1] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->min, vr1->max);
2099 if (val[1] == NULL_TREE)
2100 sop = true;
2103 if (vr0->max == vr0->min)
2104 val[2] = NULL_TREE;
2105 else
2107 val[2] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->max, vr1->min);
2108 if (val[2] == NULL_TREE)
2109 sop = true;
2112 if (vr0->min == vr0->max || vr1->min == vr1->max)
2113 val[3] = NULL_TREE;
2114 else
2116 val[3] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->max, vr1->max);
2117 if (val[3] == NULL_TREE)
2118 sop = true;
2121 if (sop)
2123 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2124 return;
2127 /* Set MIN to the minimum of VAL[i] and MAX to the maximum
2128 of VAL[i]. */
2129 min = val[0];
2130 max = val[0];
2131 for (i = 1; i < 4; i++)
2133 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (min)
2134 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
2135 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max)
2136 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2137 break;
2139 if (val[i])
2141 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val[i])
2142 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (val[i])
2143 && !is_overflow_infinity (val[i])))
2145 /* If we found an overflowed value, set MIN and MAX
2146 to it so that we set the resulting range to
2147 VARYING. */
2148 min = max = val[i];
2149 break;
2152 if (compare_values (val[i], min) == -1)
2153 min = val[i];
2155 if (compare_values (val[i], max) == 1)
2156 max = val[i];
2160 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
2161 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity
2162 representation. */
2163 if (min == NULL_TREE
2164 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (min)
2165 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
2166 || max == NULL_TREE
2167 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max)
2168 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2170 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2171 return;
2174 /* We punt if:
2175 1) [-INF, +INF]
2176 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
2177 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
2178 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
2179 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
2180 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
2181 overflow. */
2182 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min) || is_overflow_infinity (min))
2183 && (vrp_val_is_max (max) || is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2185 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2186 return;
2189 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
2190 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
2192 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
2193 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
2194 the new range VARYING. */
2195 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2197 else
2198 set_value_range (vr, type, min, max, NULL);
2201 /* Extract range information from a binary operation CODE based on
2202 the ranges of each of its operands *VR0 and *VR1 with resulting
2203 type EXPR_TYPE. The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
2205 static void
2206 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (value_range *vr,
2207 enum tree_code code, tree expr_type,
2208 value_range *vr0_, value_range *vr1_)
2210 value_range vr0 = *vr0_, vr1 = *vr1_;
2211 value_range vrtem0 = VR_INITIALIZER, vrtem1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
2212 enum value_range_type type;
2213 tree min = NULL_TREE, max = NULL_TREE;
2214 int cmp;
2216 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (expr_type)
2217 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type))
2219 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2220 return;
2223 /* Not all binary expressions can be applied to ranges in a
2224 meaningful way. Handle only arithmetic operations. */
2225 if (code != PLUS_EXPR
2226 && code != MINUS_EXPR
2227 && code != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
2228 && code != MULT_EXPR
2229 && code != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2230 && code != FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2231 && code != CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2232 && code != EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2233 && code != ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2234 && code != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2235 && code != RSHIFT_EXPR
2236 && code != LSHIFT_EXPR
2237 && code != MIN_EXPR
2238 && code != MAX_EXPR
2239 && code != BIT_AND_EXPR
2240 && code != BIT_IOR_EXPR
2241 && code != BIT_XOR_EXPR)
2243 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2244 return;
2247 /* If both ranges are UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
2248 if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED && vr1.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2250 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
2251 return;
2253 /* If one of the ranges is UNDEFINED drop it to VARYING for the following
2254 code. At some point we may want to special-case operations that
2255 have UNDEFINED result for all or some value-ranges of the not UNDEFINED
2256 operand. */
2257 else if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2258 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
2259 else if (vr1.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2260 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
2262 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
2263 and express ~[] op X as ([]' op X) U ([]'' op X). */
2264 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2265 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
2267 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &vrtem0, vr1_);
2268 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
2270 value_range vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
2271 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres, code, expr_type,
2272 &vrtem1, vr1_);
2273 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
2275 return;
2277 /* Likewise for X op ~[]. */
2278 if (vr1.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2279 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr1, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
2281 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, vr0_, &vrtem0);
2282 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
2284 value_range vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
2285 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres, code, expr_type,
2286 vr0_, &vrtem1);
2287 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
2289 return;
2292 /* The type of the resulting value range defaults to VR0.TYPE. */
2293 type = vr0.type;
2295 /* Refuse to operate on VARYING ranges, ranges of different kinds
2296 and symbolic ranges. As an exception, we allow BIT_{AND,IOR}
2297 because we may be able to derive a useful range even if one of
2298 the operands is VR_VARYING or symbolic range. Similarly for
2299 divisions, MIN/MAX and PLUS/MINUS.
2301 TODO, we may be able to derive anti-ranges in some cases. */
2302 if (code != BIT_AND_EXPR
2303 && code != BIT_IOR_EXPR
2304 && code != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2305 && code != FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2306 && code != CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2307 && code != EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2308 && code != ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2309 && code != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2310 && code != MIN_EXPR
2311 && code != MAX_EXPR
2312 && code != PLUS_EXPR
2313 && code != MINUS_EXPR
2314 && code != RSHIFT_EXPR
2315 && (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
2316 || vr1.type == VR_VARYING
2317 || vr0.type != vr1.type
2318 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0)
2319 || symbolic_range_p (&vr1)))
2321 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2322 return;
2325 /* Now evaluate the expression to determine the new range. */
2326 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type))
2328 if (code == MIN_EXPR || code == MAX_EXPR)
2330 /* For MIN/MAX expressions with pointers, we only care about
2331 nullness, if both are non null, then the result is nonnull.
2332 If both are null, then the result is null. Otherwise they
2333 are varying. */
2334 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2335 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2336 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) && range_is_null (&vr1))
2337 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2338 else
2339 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2341 else if (code == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
2343 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2344 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2345 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) || range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2346 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2347 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) && range_is_null (&vr1))
2348 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2349 else
2350 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2352 else if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
2354 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2355 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2356 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2357 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2358 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) || range_is_null (&vr1))
2359 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2360 else
2361 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2363 else
2364 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2366 return;
2369 /* For integer ranges, apply the operation to each end of the
2370 range and see what we end up with. */
2371 if (code == PLUS_EXPR || code == MINUS_EXPR)
2373 const bool minus_p = (code == MINUS_EXPR);
2374 tree min_op0 = vr0.min;
2375 tree min_op1 = minus_p ? vr1.max : vr1.min;
2376 tree max_op0 = vr0.max;
2377 tree max_op1 = minus_p ? vr1.min : vr1.max;
2378 tree sym_min_op0 = NULL_TREE;
2379 tree sym_min_op1 = NULL_TREE;
2380 tree sym_max_op0 = NULL_TREE;
2381 tree sym_max_op1 = NULL_TREE;
2382 bool neg_min_op0, neg_min_op1, neg_max_op0, neg_max_op1;
2384 /* If we have a PLUS or MINUS with two VR_RANGEs, either constant or
2385 single-symbolic ranges, try to compute the precise resulting range,
2386 but only if we know that this resulting range will also be constant
2387 or single-symbolic. */
2388 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE && vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2389 && (TREE_CODE (min_op0) == INTEGER_CST
2390 || (sym_min_op0
2391 = get_single_symbol (min_op0, &neg_min_op0, &min_op0)))
2392 && (TREE_CODE (min_op1) == INTEGER_CST
2393 || (sym_min_op1
2394 = get_single_symbol (min_op1, &neg_min_op1, &min_op1)))
2395 && (!(sym_min_op0 && sym_min_op1)
2396 || (sym_min_op0 == sym_min_op1
2397 && neg_min_op0 == (minus_p ? neg_min_op1 : !neg_min_op1)))
2398 && (TREE_CODE (max_op0) == INTEGER_CST
2399 || (sym_max_op0
2400 = get_single_symbol (max_op0, &neg_max_op0, &max_op0)))
2401 && (TREE_CODE (max_op1) == INTEGER_CST
2402 || (sym_max_op1
2403 = get_single_symbol (max_op1, &neg_max_op1, &max_op1)))
2404 && (!(sym_max_op0 && sym_max_op1)
2405 || (sym_max_op0 == sym_max_op1
2406 && neg_max_op0 == (minus_p ? neg_max_op1 : !neg_max_op1))))
2408 const signop sgn = TYPE_SIGN (expr_type);
2409 const unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type);
2410 wide_int type_min, type_max, wmin, wmax;
2411 int min_ovf = 0;
2412 int max_ovf = 0;
2414 /* Get the lower and upper bounds of the type. */
2415 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2417 type_min = wi::min_value (prec, sgn);
2418 type_max = wi::max_value (prec, sgn);
2420 else
2422 type_min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2423 type_max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2426 /* Combine the lower bounds, if any. */
2427 if (min_op0 && min_op1)
2429 if (minus_p)
2431 wmin = wi::sub (min_op0, min_op1);
2433 /* Check for overflow. */
2434 if (wi::cmp (0, min_op1, sgn)
2435 != wi::cmp (wmin, min_op0, sgn))
2436 min_ovf = wi::cmp (min_op0, min_op1, sgn);
2438 else
2440 wmin = wi::add (min_op0, min_op1);
2442 /* Check for overflow. */
2443 if (wi::cmp (min_op1, 0, sgn)
2444 != wi::cmp (wmin, min_op0, sgn))
2445 min_ovf = wi::cmp (min_op0, wmin, sgn);
2448 else if (min_op0)
2449 wmin = min_op0;
2450 else if (min_op1)
2451 wmin = minus_p ? wi::neg (min_op1) : min_op1;
2452 else
2453 wmin = wi::shwi (0, prec);
2455 /* Combine the upper bounds, if any. */
2456 if (max_op0 && max_op1)
2458 if (minus_p)
2460 wmax = wi::sub (max_op0, max_op1);
2462 /* Check for overflow. */
2463 if (wi::cmp (0, max_op1, sgn)
2464 != wi::cmp (wmax, max_op0, sgn))
2465 max_ovf = wi::cmp (max_op0, max_op1, sgn);
2467 else
2469 wmax = wi::add (max_op0, max_op1);
2471 if (wi::cmp (max_op1, 0, sgn)
2472 != wi::cmp (wmax, max_op0, sgn))
2473 max_ovf = wi::cmp (max_op0, wmax, sgn);
2476 else if (max_op0)
2477 wmax = max_op0;
2478 else if (max_op1)
2479 wmax = minus_p ? wi::neg (max_op1) : max_op1;
2480 else
2481 wmax = wi::shwi (0, prec);
2483 /* Check for type overflow. */
2484 if (min_ovf == 0)
2486 if (wi::cmp (wmin, type_min, sgn) == -1)
2487 min_ovf = -1;
2488 else if (wi::cmp (wmin, type_max, sgn) == 1)
2489 min_ovf = 1;
2491 if (max_ovf == 0)
2493 if (wi::cmp (wmax, type_min, sgn) == -1)
2494 max_ovf = -1;
2495 else if (wi::cmp (wmax, type_max, sgn) == 1)
2496 max_ovf = 1;
2499 /* If we have overflow for the constant part and the resulting
2500 range will be symbolic, drop to VR_VARYING. */
2501 if ((min_ovf && sym_min_op0 != sym_min_op1)
2502 || (max_ovf && sym_max_op0 != sym_max_op1))
2504 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2505 return;
2508 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2510 /* If overflow wraps, truncate the values and adjust the
2511 range kind and bounds appropriately. */
2512 wide_int tmin = wide_int::from (wmin, prec, sgn);
2513 wide_int tmax = wide_int::from (wmax, prec, sgn);
2514 if (min_ovf == max_ovf)
2516 /* No overflow or both overflow or underflow. The
2517 range kind stays VR_RANGE. */
2518 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmin);
2519 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmax);
2521 else if ((min_ovf == -1 && max_ovf == 0)
2522 || (max_ovf == 1 && min_ovf == 0))
2524 /* Min underflow or max overflow. The range kind
2525 changes to VR_ANTI_RANGE. */
2526 bool covers = false;
2527 wide_int tem = tmin;
2528 type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
2529 tmin = tmax + 1;
2530 if (wi::cmp (tmin, tmax, sgn) < 0)
2531 covers = true;
2532 tmax = tem - 1;
2533 if (wi::cmp (tmax, tem, sgn) > 0)
2534 covers = true;
2535 /* If the anti-range would cover nothing, drop to varying.
2536 Likewise if the anti-range bounds are outside of the
2537 types values. */
2538 if (covers || wi::cmp (tmin, tmax, sgn) > 0)
2540 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2541 return;
2543 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmin);
2544 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmax);
2546 else
2548 /* Other underflow and/or overflow, drop to VR_VARYING. */
2549 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2550 return;
2553 else
2555 /* If overflow does not wrap, saturate to the types min/max
2556 value. */
2557 if (min_ovf == -1)
2559 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2560 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2561 min = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2562 else
2563 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_min);
2565 else if (min_ovf == 1)
2567 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2568 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2569 min = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2570 else
2571 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_max);
2573 else
2574 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmin);
2576 if (max_ovf == -1)
2578 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2579 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2580 max = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2581 else
2582 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_min);
2584 else if (max_ovf == 1)
2586 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2587 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2588 max = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2589 else
2590 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_max);
2592 else
2593 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmax);
2596 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2597 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2599 if ((min_op0 && is_negative_overflow_infinity (min_op0))
2600 || (min_op1
2601 && (minus_p
2602 ? is_positive_overflow_infinity (min_op1)
2603 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (min_op1))))
2604 min = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2605 if ((max_op0 && is_positive_overflow_infinity (max_op0))
2606 || (max_op1
2607 && (minus_p
2608 ? is_negative_overflow_infinity (max_op1)
2609 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (max_op1))))
2610 max = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2613 /* If the result lower bound is constant, we're done;
2614 otherwise, build the symbolic lower bound. */
2615 if (sym_min_op0 == sym_min_op1)
2617 else if (sym_min_op0)
2618 min = build_symbolic_expr (expr_type, sym_min_op0,
2619 neg_min_op0, min);
2620 else if (sym_min_op1)
2621 min = build_symbolic_expr (expr_type, sym_min_op1,
2622 neg_min_op1 ^ minus_p, min);
2624 /* Likewise for the upper bound. */
2625 if (sym_max_op0 == sym_max_op1)
2627 else if (sym_max_op0)
2628 max = build_symbolic_expr (expr_type, sym_max_op0,
2629 neg_max_op0, max);
2630 else if (sym_max_op1)
2631 max = build_symbolic_expr (expr_type, sym_max_op1,
2632 neg_max_op1 ^ minus_p, max);
2634 else
2636 /* For other cases, for example if we have a PLUS_EXPR with two
2637 VR_ANTI_RANGEs, drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort
2638 to compute a precise range for such a case.
2639 ??? General even mixed range kind operations can be expressed
2640 by for example transforming ~[3, 5] + [1, 2] to range-only
2641 operations and a union primitive:
2642 [-INF, 2] + [1, 2] U [5, +INF] + [1, 2]
2643 [-INF+1, 4] U [6, +INF(OVF)]
2644 though usually the union is not exactly representable with
2645 a single range or anti-range as the above is
2646 [-INF+1, +INF(OVF)] intersected with ~[5, 5]
2647 but one could use a scheme similar to equivalences for this. */
2648 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2649 return;
2652 else if (code == MIN_EXPR
2653 || code == MAX_EXPR)
2655 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
2656 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
2658 type = VR_RANGE;
2659 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2660 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
2662 /* For operations that make the resulting range directly
2663 proportional to the original ranges, apply the operation to
2664 the same end of each range. */
2665 min = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0.min, vr1.min);
2666 max = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0.max, vr1.max);
2668 else if (code == MIN_EXPR)
2670 min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2671 max = vr0.max;
2673 else if (code == MAX_EXPR)
2675 min = vr0.min;
2676 max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2679 else if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2680 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
2682 type = VR_RANGE;
2683 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
2685 min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2686 max = vr1.max;
2688 else if (code == MAX_EXPR)
2690 min = vr1.min;
2691 max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2694 else
2696 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2697 return;
2700 else if (code == MULT_EXPR)
2702 /* Fancy code so that with unsigned, [-3,-1]*[-3,-1] does not
2703 drop to varying. This test requires 2*prec bits if both
2704 operands are signed and 2*prec + 2 bits if either is not. */
2706 signop sign = TYPE_SIGN (expr_type);
2707 unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type);
2709 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr0)
2710 && range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
2711 && TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2713 typedef FIXED_WIDE_INT (WIDE_INT_MAX_PRECISION * 2) vrp_int;
2714 typedef generic_wide_int
2715 <wi::extended_tree <WIDE_INT_MAX_PRECISION * 2> > vrp_int_cst;
2716 vrp_int sizem1 = wi::mask <vrp_int> (prec, false);
2717 vrp_int size = sizem1 + 1;
2719 /* Extend the values using the sign of the result to PREC2.
2720 From here on out, everthing is just signed math no matter
2721 what the input types were. */
2722 vrp_int min0 = vrp_int_cst (vr0.min);
2723 vrp_int max0 = vrp_int_cst (vr0.max);
2724 vrp_int min1 = vrp_int_cst (vr1.min);
2725 vrp_int max1 = vrp_int_cst (vr1.max);
2726 /* Canonicalize the intervals. */
2727 if (sign == UNSIGNED)
2729 if (wi::ltu_p (size, min0 + max0))
2731 min0 -= size;
2732 max0 -= size;
2735 if (wi::ltu_p (size, min1 + max1))
2737 min1 -= size;
2738 max1 -= size;
2742 vrp_int prod0 = min0 * min1;
2743 vrp_int prod1 = min0 * max1;
2744 vrp_int prod2 = max0 * min1;
2745 vrp_int prod3 = max0 * max1;
2747 /* Sort the 4 products so that min is in prod0 and max is in
2748 prod3. */
2749 /* min0min1 > max0max1 */
2750 if (prod0 > prod3)
2751 std::swap (prod0, prod3);
2753 /* min0max1 > max0min1 */
2754 if (prod1 > prod2)
2755 std::swap (prod1, prod2);
2757 if (prod0 > prod1)
2758 std::swap (prod0, prod1);
2760 if (prod2 > prod3)
2761 std::swap (prod2, prod3);
2763 /* diff = max - min. */
2764 prod2 = prod3 - prod0;
2765 if (wi::geu_p (prod2, sizem1))
2767 /* the range covers all values. */
2768 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2769 return;
2772 /* The following should handle the wrapping and selecting
2773 VR_ANTI_RANGE for us. */
2774 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, prod0);
2775 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, prod3);
2776 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, NULL);
2777 return;
2780 /* If we have an unsigned MULT_EXPR with two VR_ANTI_RANGEs,
2781 drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort to compute a
2782 precise range for such a case. For example, if we have
2783 op0 == 65536 and op1 == 65536 with their ranges both being
2784 ~[0,0] on a 32-bit machine, we would have op0 * op1 == 0, so
2785 we cannot claim that the product is in ~[0,0]. Note that we
2786 are guaranteed to have vr0.type == vr1.type at this
2787 point. */
2788 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2789 && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (expr_type))
2791 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2792 return;
2795 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2796 return;
2798 else if (code == RSHIFT_EXPR
2799 || code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
2801 /* If we have a RSHIFT_EXPR with any shift values outside [0..prec-1],
2802 then drop to VR_VARYING. Outside of this range we get undefined
2803 behavior from the shift operation. We cannot even trust
2804 SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED at this stage, because that applies to rtl
2805 shifts, and the operation at the tree level may be widened. */
2806 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
2807 && compare_tree_int (vr1.min, 0) >= 0
2808 && compare_tree_int (vr1.max, TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type)) == -1)
2810 if (code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
2812 /* Even if vr0 is VARYING or otherwise not usable, we can derive
2813 useful ranges just from the shift count. E.g.
2814 x >> 63 for signed 64-bit x is always [-1, 0]. */
2815 if (vr0.type != VR_RANGE || symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
2817 vr0.type = type = VR_RANGE;
2818 vr0.min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2819 vr0.max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2821 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2822 return;
2824 /* We can map lshifts by constants to MULT_EXPR handling. */
2825 else if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
2826 && range_int_cst_singleton_p (&vr1))
2828 bool saved_flag_wrapv;
2829 value_range vr1p = VR_INITIALIZER;
2830 vr1p.type = VR_RANGE;
2831 vr1p.min = (wide_int_to_tree
2832 (expr_type,
2833 wi::set_bit_in_zero (tree_to_shwi (vr1.min),
2834 TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type))));
2835 vr1p.max = vr1p.min;
2836 /* We have to use a wrapping multiply though as signed overflow
2837 on lshifts is implementation defined in C89. */
2838 saved_flag_wrapv = flag_wrapv;
2839 flag_wrapv = 1;
2840 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MULT_EXPR, expr_type,
2841 &vr0, &vr1p);
2842 flag_wrapv = saved_flag_wrapv;
2843 return;
2845 else if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
2846 && range_int_cst_p (&vr0))
2848 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type);
2849 int overflow_pos = prec;
2850 int bound_shift;
2851 wide_int low_bound, high_bound;
2852 bool uns = TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type);
2853 bool in_bounds = false;
2855 if (!uns)
2856 overflow_pos -= 1;
2858 bound_shift = overflow_pos - tree_to_shwi (vr1.max);
2859 /* If bound_shift == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, the llshift can
2860 overflow. However, for that to happen, vr1.max needs to be
2861 zero, which means vr1 is a singleton range of zero, which
2862 means it should be handled by the previous LSHIFT_EXPR
2863 if-clause. */
2864 wide_int bound = wi::set_bit_in_zero (bound_shift, prec);
2865 wide_int complement = ~(bound - 1);
2867 if (uns)
2869 low_bound = bound;
2870 high_bound = complement;
2871 if (wi::ltu_p (vr0.max, low_bound))
2873 /* [5, 6] << [1, 2] == [10, 24]. */
2874 /* We're shifting out only zeroes, the value increases
2875 monotonically. */
2876 in_bounds = true;
2878 else if (wi::ltu_p (high_bound, vr0.min))
2880 /* [0xffffff00, 0xffffffff] << [1, 2]
2881 == [0xfffffc00, 0xfffffffe]. */
2882 /* We're shifting out only ones, the value decreases
2883 monotonically. */
2884 in_bounds = true;
2887 else
2889 /* [-1, 1] << [1, 2] == [-4, 4]. */
2890 low_bound = complement;
2891 high_bound = bound;
2892 if (wi::lts_p (vr0.max, high_bound)
2893 && wi::lts_p (low_bound, vr0.min))
2895 /* For non-negative numbers, we're shifting out only
2896 zeroes, the value increases monotonically.
2897 For negative numbers, we're shifting out only ones, the
2898 value decreases monotomically. */
2899 in_bounds = true;
2903 if (in_bounds)
2905 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2906 return;
2910 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2911 return;
2913 else if (code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2914 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2915 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2916 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2917 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR)
2919 if (vr0.type != VR_RANGE || symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
2921 /* For division, if op1 has VR_RANGE but op0 does not, something
2922 can be deduced just from that range. Say [min, max] / [4, max]
2923 gives [min / 4, max / 4] range. */
2924 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2925 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1)
2926 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) == 0)
2928 vr0.type = type = VR_RANGE;
2929 vr0.min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2930 vr0.max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2932 else
2934 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2935 return;
2939 /* For divisions, if flag_non_call_exceptions is true, we must
2940 not eliminate a division by zero. */
2941 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions
2942 && (vr1.type != VR_RANGE
2943 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) != 0))
2945 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2946 return;
2949 /* For divisions, if op0 is VR_RANGE, we can deduce a range
2950 even if op1 is VR_VARYING, VR_ANTI_RANGE, symbolic or can
2951 include 0. */
2952 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
2953 && (vr1.type != VR_RANGE
2954 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) != 0))
2956 tree zero = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr0.min), 0);
2957 int cmp;
2959 min = NULL_TREE;
2960 max = NULL_TREE;
2961 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type)
2962 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr1))
2964 /* For unsigned division or when divisor is known
2965 to be non-negative, the range has to cover
2966 all numbers from 0 to max for positive max
2967 and all numbers from min to 0 for negative min. */
2968 cmp = compare_values (vr0.max, zero);
2969 if (cmp == -1)
2971 /* When vr0.max < 0, vr1.min != 0 and value
2972 ranges for dividend and divisor are available. */
2973 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2974 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr0)
2975 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1)
2976 && compare_values (vr1.min, zero) != 0)
2977 max = int_const_binop (code, vr0.max, vr1.min);
2978 else
2979 max = zero;
2981 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == 1)
2982 max = vr0.max;
2983 else
2984 type = VR_VARYING;
2985 cmp = compare_values (vr0.min, zero);
2986 if (cmp == 1)
2988 /* For unsigned division when value ranges for dividend
2989 and divisor are available. */
2990 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2991 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr0)
2992 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1)
2993 && compare_values (vr1.max, zero) != 0)
2994 min = int_const_binop (code, vr0.min, vr1.max);
2995 else
2996 min = zero;
2998 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == -1)
2999 min = vr0.min;
3000 else
3001 type = VR_VARYING;
3003 else
3005 /* Otherwise the range is -max .. max or min .. -min
3006 depending on which bound is bigger in absolute value,
3007 as the division can change the sign. */
3008 abs_extent_range (vr, vr0.min, vr0.max);
3009 return;
3011 if (type == VR_VARYING)
3013 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3014 return;
3017 else if (!symbolic_range_p (&vr0) && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
3019 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
3020 return;
3023 else if (code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR)
3025 if (range_is_null (&vr1))
3027 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
3028 return;
3030 /* ABS (A % B) < ABS (B) and either
3031 0 <= A % B <= A or A <= A % B <= 0. */
3032 type = VR_RANGE;
3033 signop sgn = TYPE_SIGN (expr_type);
3034 unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type);
3035 wide_int wmin, wmax, tmp;
3036 wide_int zero = wi::zero (prec);
3037 wide_int one = wi::one (prec);
3038 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
3040 wmax = wi::sub (vr1.max, one);
3041 if (sgn == SIGNED)
3043 tmp = wi::sub (wi::minus_one (prec), vr1.min);
3044 wmax = wi::smax (wmax, tmp);
3047 else
3049 wmax = wi::max_value (prec, sgn);
3050 /* X % INT_MIN may be INT_MAX. */
3051 if (sgn == UNSIGNED)
3052 wmax = wmax - one;
3055 if (sgn == UNSIGNED)
3056 wmin = zero;
3057 else
3059 wmin = -wmax;
3060 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE && TREE_CODE (vr0.min) == INTEGER_CST)
3062 tmp = vr0.min;
3063 if (wi::gts_p (tmp, zero))
3064 tmp = zero;
3065 wmin = wi::smax (wmin, tmp);
3069 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE && TREE_CODE (vr0.max) == INTEGER_CST)
3071 tmp = vr0.max;
3072 if (sgn == SIGNED && wi::neg_p (tmp))
3073 tmp = zero;
3074 wmax = wi::min (wmax, tmp, sgn);
3077 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmin);
3078 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmax);
3080 else if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR || code == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
3082 bool int_cst_range0, int_cst_range1;
3083 wide_int may_be_nonzero0, may_be_nonzero1;
3084 wide_int must_be_nonzero0, must_be_nonzero1;
3086 int_cst_range0 = zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (expr_type, &vr0,
3087 &may_be_nonzero0,
3088 &must_be_nonzero0);
3089 int_cst_range1 = zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (expr_type, &vr1,
3090 &may_be_nonzero1,
3091 &must_be_nonzero1);
3093 type = VR_RANGE;
3094 if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
3096 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type,
3097 must_be_nonzero0 & must_be_nonzero1);
3098 wide_int wmax = may_be_nonzero0 & may_be_nonzero1;
3099 /* If both input ranges contain only negative values we can
3100 truncate the result range maximum to the minimum of the
3101 input range maxima. */
3102 if (int_cst_range0 && int_cst_range1
3103 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.max) < 0
3104 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.max) < 0)
3106 wmax = wi::min (wmax, vr0.max, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3107 wmax = wi::min (wmax, vr1.max, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3109 /* If either input range contains only non-negative values
3110 we can truncate the result range maximum to the respective
3111 maximum of the input range. */
3112 if (int_cst_range0 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.min) >= 0)
3113 wmax = wi::min (wmax, vr0.max, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3114 if (int_cst_range1 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.min) >= 0)
3115 wmax = wi::min (wmax, vr1.max, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3116 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmax);
3117 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3118 /* PR68217: In case of signed & sign-bit-CST should
3119 result in [-INF, 0] instead of [-INF, INF]. */
3120 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
3122 wide_int sign_bit
3123 = wi::set_bit_in_zero (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type) - 1,
3124 TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type));
3125 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type)
3126 && ((value_range_constant_singleton (&vr0)
3127 && !wi::cmps (vr0.min, sign_bit))
3128 || (value_range_constant_singleton (&vr1)
3129 && !wi::cmps (vr1.min, sign_bit))))
3131 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (expr_type);
3132 max = build_int_cst (expr_type, 0);
3136 else if (code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
3138 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type,
3139 may_be_nonzero0 | may_be_nonzero1);
3140 wide_int wmin = must_be_nonzero0 | must_be_nonzero1;
3141 /* If the input ranges contain only positive values we can
3142 truncate the minimum of the result range to the maximum
3143 of the input range minima. */
3144 if (int_cst_range0 && int_cst_range1
3145 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.min) >= 0
3146 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.min) >= 0)
3148 wmin = wi::max (wmin, vr0.min, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3149 wmin = wi::max (wmin, vr1.min, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3151 /* If either input range contains only negative values
3152 we can truncate the minimum of the result range to the
3153 respective minimum range. */
3154 if (int_cst_range0 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.max) < 0)
3155 wmin = wi::max (wmin, vr0.min, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3156 if (int_cst_range1 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.max) < 0)
3157 wmin = wi::max (wmin, vr1.min, TYPE_SIGN (expr_type));
3158 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, wmin);
3160 else if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
3162 wide_int result_zero_bits = ((must_be_nonzero0 & must_be_nonzero1)
3163 | ~(may_be_nonzero0 | may_be_nonzero1));
3164 wide_int result_one_bits
3165 = (must_be_nonzero0.and_not (may_be_nonzero1)
3166 | must_be_nonzero1.and_not (may_be_nonzero0));
3167 max = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, ~result_zero_bits);
3168 min = wide_int_to_tree (expr_type, result_one_bits);
3169 /* If the range has all positive or all negative values the
3170 result is better than VARYING. */
3171 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (min) < 0
3172 || tree_int_cst_sgn (max) >= 0)
3174 else
3175 max = min = NULL_TREE;
3178 else
3179 gcc_unreachable ();
3181 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
3182 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity representation. */
3183 if (min == NULL_TREE
3184 || (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
3185 || max == NULL_TREE
3186 || (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
3188 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3189 return;
3192 /* We punt if:
3193 1) [-INF, +INF]
3194 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
3195 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
3196 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
3197 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
3198 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
3199 overflow. */
3200 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min) || is_overflow_infinity (min))
3201 && (vrp_val_is_max (max) || is_overflow_infinity (max)))
3203 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3204 return;
3207 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3208 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
3210 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3211 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3212 the new range VARYING. */
3213 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3215 else
3216 set_value_range (vr, type, min, max, NULL);
3219 /* Extract range information from a binary expression OP0 CODE OP1 based on
3220 the ranges of each of its operands with resulting type EXPR_TYPE.
3221 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3223 static void
3224 extract_range_from_binary_expr (value_range *vr,
3225 enum tree_code code,
3226 tree expr_type, tree op0, tree op1)
3228 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3229 value_range vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3231 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3232 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3233 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3234 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3235 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3236 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3237 else
3238 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3240 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
3241 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
3242 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
3243 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
3244 else
3245 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
3247 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &vr0, &vr1);
3249 /* Try harder for PLUS and MINUS if the range of one operand is symbolic
3250 and based on the other operand, for example if it was deduced from a
3251 symbolic comparison. When a bound of the range of the first operand
3252 is invariant, we set the corresponding bound of the new range to INF
3253 in order to avoid recursing on the range of the second operand. */
3254 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING
3255 && (code == PLUS_EXPR || code == MINUS_EXPR)
3256 && TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME
3257 && vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3258 && symbolic_range_based_on_p (&vr0, op1))
3260 const bool minus_p = (code == MINUS_EXPR);
3261 value_range n_vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3263 /* Try with VR0 and [-INF, OP1]. */
3264 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (minus_p ? vr0.max : vr0.min))
3265 set_value_range (&n_vr1, VR_RANGE, vrp_val_min (expr_type), op1, NULL);
3267 /* Try with VR0 and [OP1, +INF]. */
3268 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (minus_p ? vr0.min : vr0.max))
3269 set_value_range (&n_vr1, VR_RANGE, op1, vrp_val_max (expr_type), NULL);
3271 /* Try with VR0 and [OP1, OP1]. */
3272 else
3273 set_value_range (&n_vr1, VR_RANGE, op1, op1, NULL);
3275 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &vr0, &n_vr1);
3278 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING
3279 && (code == PLUS_EXPR || code == MINUS_EXPR)
3280 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
3281 && vr1.type == VR_RANGE
3282 && symbolic_range_based_on_p (&vr1, op0))
3284 const bool minus_p = (code == MINUS_EXPR);
3285 value_range n_vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3287 /* Try with [-INF, OP0] and VR1. */
3288 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (minus_p ? vr1.max : vr1.min))
3289 set_value_range (&n_vr0, VR_RANGE, vrp_val_min (expr_type), op0, NULL);
3291 /* Try with [OP0, +INF] and VR1. */
3292 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (minus_p ? vr1.min : vr1.max))
3293 set_value_range (&n_vr0, VR_RANGE, op0, vrp_val_max (expr_type), NULL);
3295 /* Try with [OP0, OP0] and VR1. */
3296 else
3297 set_value_range (&n_vr0, VR_RANGE, op0, op0, NULL);
3299 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &n_vr0, &vr1);
3303 /* Extract range information from a unary operation CODE based on
3304 the range of its operand *VR0 with type OP0_TYPE with resulting type TYPE.
3305 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3307 void
3308 extract_range_from_unary_expr (value_range *vr,
3309 enum tree_code code, tree type,
3310 value_range *vr0_, tree op0_type)
3312 value_range vr0 = *vr0_, vrtem0 = VR_INITIALIZER, vrtem1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3314 /* VRP only operates on integral and pointer types. */
3315 if (!(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (op0_type)
3316 || POINTER_TYPE_P (op0_type))
3317 || !(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
3318 || POINTER_TYPE_P (type)))
3320 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3321 return;
3324 /* If VR0 is UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
3325 if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
3327 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
3328 return;
3331 /* Handle operations that we express in terms of others. */
3332 if (code == PAREN_EXPR || code == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
3334 /* PAREN_EXPR and OBJ_TYPE_REF are simple copies. */
3335 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3336 return;
3338 else if (code == NEGATE_EXPR)
3340 /* -X is simply 0 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3341 anti-ranges fine. */
3342 value_range zero = VR_INITIALIZER;
3343 set_value_range_to_value (&zero, build_int_cst (type, 0), NULL);
3344 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MINUS_EXPR, type, &zero, &vr0);
3345 return;
3347 else if (code == BIT_NOT_EXPR)
3349 /* ~X is simply -1 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3350 anti-ranges fine. */
3351 value_range minusone = VR_INITIALIZER;
3352 set_value_range_to_value (&minusone, build_int_cst (type, -1), NULL);
3353 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MINUS_EXPR,
3354 type, &minusone, &vr0);
3355 return;
3358 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
3359 and express op ~[] as (op []') U (op []''). */
3360 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3361 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
3363 extract_range_from_unary_expr (vr, code, type, &vrtem0, op0_type);
3364 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
3366 value_range vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
3367 extract_range_from_unary_expr (&vrres, code, type,
3368 &vrtem1, op0_type);
3369 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
3371 return;
3374 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code))
3376 tree inner_type = op0_type;
3377 tree outer_type = type;
3379 /* If the expression evaluates to a pointer, we are only interested in
3380 determining if it evaluates to NULL [0, 0] or non-NULL (~[0, 0]). */
3381 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type))
3383 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0))
3384 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, type);
3385 else if (range_is_null (&vr0))
3386 set_value_range_to_null (vr, type);
3387 else
3388 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3389 return;
3392 /* If VR0 is varying and we increase the type precision, assume
3393 a full range for the following transformation. */
3394 if (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
3395 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (inner_type)
3396 && TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type) < TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type))
3398 vr0.type = VR_RANGE;
3399 vr0.min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (inner_type);
3400 vr0.max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (inner_type);
3403 /* If VR0 is a constant range or anti-range and the conversion is
3404 not truncating we can convert the min and max values and
3405 canonicalize the resulting range. Otherwise we can do the
3406 conversion if the size of the range is less than what the
3407 precision of the target type can represent and the range is
3408 not an anti-range. */
3409 if ((vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3410 || vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3411 && TREE_CODE (vr0.min) == INTEGER_CST
3412 && TREE_CODE (vr0.max) == INTEGER_CST
3413 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min)
3414 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3415 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3416 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type)
3417 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type)))
3418 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max)
3419 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3420 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3421 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type)
3422 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type)))
3423 && (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) >= TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3424 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3425 && integer_zerop (int_const_binop (RSHIFT_EXPR,
3426 int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr0.max, vr0.min),
3427 size_int (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type)))))))
3429 tree new_min, new_max;
3430 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min))
3431 new_min = negative_overflow_infinity (outer_type);
3432 else
3433 new_min = force_fit_type (outer_type, wi::to_widest (vr0.min),
3434 0, false);
3435 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max))
3436 new_max = positive_overflow_infinity (outer_type);
3437 else
3438 new_max = force_fit_type (outer_type, wi::to_widest (vr0.max),
3439 0, false);
3440 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, vr0.type,
3441 new_min, new_max, NULL);
3442 return;
3445 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3446 return;
3448 else if (code == ABS_EXPR)
3450 tree min, max;
3451 int cmp;
3453 /* Pass through vr0 in the easy cases. */
3454 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
3455 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr0))
3457 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3458 return;
3461 /* For the remaining varying or symbolic ranges we can't do anything
3462 useful. */
3463 if (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
3464 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
3466 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3467 return;
3470 /* -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE with flag_wrapv so we can't get a
3471 useful range. */
3472 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (type)
3473 && ((vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3474 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))
3475 || (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3476 && !vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))))
3478 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3479 return;
3482 /* ABS_EXPR may flip the range around, if the original range
3483 included negative values. */
3484 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min))
3485 min = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3486 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))
3487 min = fold_unary_to_constant (code, type, vr0.min);
3488 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3489 min = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3490 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type))
3491 min = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3492 else
3494 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3495 return;
3498 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max))
3499 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3500 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0.max))
3501 max = fold_unary_to_constant (code, type, vr0.max);
3502 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3503 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3504 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type)
3505 /* We shouldn't generate [+INF, +INF] as set_value_range
3506 doesn't like this and ICEs. */
3507 && !is_positive_overflow_infinity (min))
3508 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3509 else
3511 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3512 return;
3515 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3517 /* If a VR_ANTI_RANGEs contains zero, then we have
3518 ~[-INF, min(MIN, MAX)]. */
3519 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3521 if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0.min, vr0.max) == 1)
3523 /* Take the lower of the two values. */
3524 if (cmp != 1)
3525 max = min;
3527 /* Create ~[-INF, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))]
3528 or ~[-INF + 1, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))] when
3529 flag_wrapv is set and the original anti-range doesn't include
3530 TYPE_MIN_VALUE, remember -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE. */
3531 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type))
3533 tree type_min_value = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
3535 min = (vr0.min != type_min_value
3536 ? int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, type_min_value,
3537 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (type_min_value), 1))
3538 : type_min_value);
3540 else
3542 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (&vr0))
3543 min = negative_overflow_infinity (type);
3544 else
3545 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
3548 else
3550 /* All else has failed, so create the range [0, INF], even for
3551 flag_wrapv since TYPE_MIN_VALUE is in the original
3552 anti-range. */
3553 vr0.type = VR_RANGE;
3554 min = build_int_cst (type, 0);
3555 if (needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3557 if (supports_overflow_infinity (type))
3558 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3559 else
3561 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3562 return;
3565 else
3566 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3570 /* If the range contains zero then we know that the minimum value in the
3571 range will be zero. */
3572 else if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0.min, vr0.max) == 1)
3574 if (cmp == 1)
3575 max = min;
3576 min = build_int_cst (type, 0);
3578 else
3580 /* If the range was reversed, swap MIN and MAX. */
3581 if (cmp == 1)
3582 std::swap (min, max);
3585 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3586 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
3588 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3589 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3590 the new range VARYING. */
3591 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3593 else
3594 set_value_range (vr, vr0.type, min, max, NULL);
3595 return;
3598 /* For unhandled operations fall back to varying. */
3599 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3600 return;
3604 /* Extract range information from a unary expression CODE OP0 based on
3605 the range of its operand with resulting type TYPE.
3606 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3608 static void
3609 extract_range_from_unary_expr (value_range *vr, enum tree_code code,
3610 tree type, tree op0)
3612 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3614 /* Get value ranges for the operand. For constant operands, create
3615 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3616 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3617 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3618 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3619 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3620 else
3621 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3623 extract_range_from_unary_expr (vr, code, type, &vr0, TREE_TYPE (op0));
3627 /* Extract range information from a conditional expression STMT based on
3628 the ranges of each of its operands and the expression code. */
3630 static void
3631 extract_range_from_cond_expr (value_range *vr, gassign *stmt)
3633 tree op0, op1;
3634 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3635 value_range vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3637 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3638 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3639 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
3640 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3641 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3642 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3643 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3644 else
3645 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3647 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs3 (stmt);
3648 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
3649 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
3650 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
3651 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
3652 else
3653 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
3655 /* The resulting value range is the union of the operand ranges */
3656 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3657 vrp_meet (vr, &vr1);
3661 /* Extract range information from a comparison expression EXPR based
3662 on the range of its operand and the expression code. */
3664 static void
3665 extract_range_from_comparison (value_range *vr, enum tree_code code,
3666 tree type, tree op0, tree op1)
3668 bool sop = false;
3669 tree val;
3671 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code, op0, op1, false, &sop,
3672 NULL);
3674 /* A disadvantage of using a special infinity as an overflow
3675 representation is that we lose the ability to record overflow
3676 when we don't have an infinity. So we have to ignore a result
3677 which relies on overflow. */
3679 if (val && !is_overflow_infinity (val) && !sop)
3681 /* Since this expression was found on the RHS of an assignment,
3682 its type may be different from _Bool. Convert VAL to EXPR's
3683 type. */
3684 val = fold_convert (type, val);
3685 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (val))
3686 set_value_range_to_value (vr, val, vr->equiv);
3687 else
3688 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, val, val, vr->equiv);
3690 else
3691 /* The result of a comparison is always true or false. */
3692 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (vr, type);
3695 /* Helper function for simplify_internal_call_using_ranges and
3696 extract_range_basic. Return true if OP0 SUBCODE OP1 for
3697 SUBCODE {PLUS,MINUS,MULT}_EXPR is known to never overflow or
3698 always overflow. Set *OVF to true if it is known to always
3699 overflow. */
3701 static bool
3702 check_for_binary_op_overflow (enum tree_code subcode, tree type,
3703 tree op0, tree op1, bool *ovf)
3705 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3706 value_range vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3707 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3708 vr0 = *get_value_range (op0);
3709 else if (TREE_CODE (op0) == INTEGER_CST)
3710 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3711 else
3712 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3714 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
3715 vr1 = *get_value_range (op1);
3716 else if (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST)
3717 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
3718 else
3719 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
3721 if (!range_int_cst_p (&vr0)
3722 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr0.min)
3723 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr0.max))
3725 vr0.min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (op0));
3726 vr0.max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (op0));
3728 if (!range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
3729 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr1.min)
3730 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr1.max))
3732 vr1.min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (op1));
3733 vr1.max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (op1));
3735 *ovf = arith_overflowed_p (subcode, type, vr0.min,
3736 subcode == MINUS_EXPR ? vr1.max : vr1.min);
3737 if (arith_overflowed_p (subcode, type, vr0.max,
3738 subcode == MINUS_EXPR ? vr1.min : vr1.max) != *ovf)
3739 return false;
3740 if (subcode == MULT_EXPR)
3742 if (arith_overflowed_p (subcode, type, vr0.min, vr1.max) != *ovf
3743 || arith_overflowed_p (subcode, type, vr0.max, vr1.min) != *ovf)
3744 return false;
3746 if (*ovf)
3748 /* So far we found that there is an overflow on the boundaries.
3749 That doesn't prove that there is an overflow even for all values
3750 in between the boundaries. For that compute widest_int range
3751 of the result and see if it doesn't overlap the range of
3752 type. */
3753 widest_int wmin, wmax;
3754 widest_int w[4];
3755 int i;
3756 w[0] = wi::to_widest (vr0.min);
3757 w[1] = wi::to_widest (vr0.max);
3758 w[2] = wi::to_widest (vr1.min);
3759 w[3] = wi::to_widest (vr1.max);
3760 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
3762 widest_int wt;
3763 switch (subcode)
3765 case PLUS_EXPR:
3766 wt = wi::add (w[i & 1], w[2 + (i & 2) / 2]);
3767 break;
3768 case MINUS_EXPR:
3769 wt = wi::sub (w[i & 1], w[2 + (i & 2) / 2]);
3770 break;
3771 case MULT_EXPR:
3772 wt = wi::mul (w[i & 1], w[2 + (i & 2) / 2]);
3773 break;
3774 default:
3775 gcc_unreachable ();
3777 if (i == 0)
3779 wmin = wt;
3780 wmax = wt;
3782 else
3784 wmin = wi::smin (wmin, wt);
3785 wmax = wi::smax (wmax, wt);
3788 /* The result of op0 CODE op1 is known to be in range
3789 [wmin, wmax]. */
3790 widest_int wtmin = wi::to_widest (vrp_val_min (type));
3791 widest_int wtmax = wi::to_widest (vrp_val_max (type));
3792 /* If all values in [wmin, wmax] are smaller than
3793 [wtmin, wtmax] or all are larger than [wtmin, wtmax],
3794 the arithmetic operation will always overflow. */
3795 if (wmax < wtmin || wmin > wtmax)
3796 return true;
3797 return false;
3799 return true;
3802 /* Try to derive a nonnegative or nonzero range out of STMT relying
3803 primarily on generic routines in fold in conjunction with range data.
3804 Store the result in *VR */
3806 static void
3807 extract_range_basic (value_range *vr, gimple *stmt)
3809 bool sop = false;
3810 tree type = gimple_expr_type (stmt);
3812 if (is_gimple_call (stmt))
3814 tree arg;
3815 int mini, maxi, zerov = 0, prec;
3816 enum tree_code subcode = ERROR_MARK;
3817 combined_fn cfn = gimple_call_combined_fn (stmt);
3819 switch (cfn)
3821 case CFN_BUILT_IN_CONSTANT_P:
3822 /* If the call is __builtin_constant_p and the argument is a
3823 function parameter resolve it to false. This avoids bogus
3824 array bound warnings.
3825 ??? We could do this as early as inlining is finished. */
3826 arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3827 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME
3828 && SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (arg)
3829 && TREE_CODE (SSA_NAME_VAR (arg)) == PARM_DECL
3830 && cfun->after_inlining)
3832 set_value_range_to_null (vr, type);
3833 return;
3835 break;
3836 /* Both __builtin_ffs* and __builtin_popcount return
3837 [0, prec]. */
3838 CASE_CFN_FFS:
3839 CASE_CFN_POPCOUNT:
3840 arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3841 prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (arg));
3842 mini = 0;
3843 maxi = prec;
3844 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
3846 value_range *vr0 = get_value_range (arg);
3847 /* If arg is non-zero, then ffs or popcount
3848 are non-zero. */
3849 if (((vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3850 && range_includes_zero_p (vr0->min, vr0->max) == 0)
3851 || (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3852 && range_includes_zero_p (vr0->min, vr0->max) == 1))
3853 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->min)
3854 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->max))
3855 mini = 1;
3856 /* If some high bits are known to be zero,
3857 we can decrease the maximum. */
3858 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3859 && TREE_CODE (vr0->max) == INTEGER_CST
3860 && !operand_less_p (vr0->min,
3861 build_zero_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr0->min)))
3862 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->max))
3863 maxi = tree_floor_log2 (vr0->max) + 1;
3865 goto bitop_builtin;
3866 /* __builtin_parity* returns [0, 1]. */
3867 CASE_CFN_PARITY:
3868 mini = 0;
3869 maxi = 1;
3870 goto bitop_builtin;
3871 /* __builtin_c[lt]z* return [0, prec-1], except for
3872 when the argument is 0, but that is undefined behavior.
3873 On many targets where the CLZ RTL or optab value is defined
3874 for 0 the value is prec, so include that in the range
3875 by default. */
3876 CASE_CFN_CLZ:
3877 arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3878 prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (arg));
3879 mini = 0;
3880 maxi = prec;
3881 if (optab_handler (clz_optab, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)))
3882 != CODE_FOR_nothing
3883 && CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)),
3884 zerov)
3885 /* Handle only the single common value. */
3886 && zerov != prec)
3887 /* Magic value to give up, unless vr0 proves
3888 arg is non-zero. */
3889 mini = -2;
3890 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
3892 value_range *vr0 = get_value_range (arg);
3893 /* From clz of VR_RANGE minimum we can compute
3894 result maximum. */
3895 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3896 && TREE_CODE (vr0->min) == INTEGER_CST
3897 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->min))
3899 maxi = prec - 1 - tree_floor_log2 (vr0->min);
3900 if (maxi != prec)
3901 mini = 0;
3903 else if (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3904 && integer_zerop (vr0->min)
3905 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->min))
3907 maxi = prec - 1;
3908 mini = 0;
3910 if (mini == -2)
3911 break;
3912 /* From clz of VR_RANGE maximum we can compute
3913 result minimum. */
3914 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3915 && TREE_CODE (vr0->max) == INTEGER_CST
3916 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->max))
3918 mini = prec - 1 - tree_floor_log2 (vr0->max);
3919 if (mini == prec)
3920 break;
3923 if (mini == -2)
3924 break;
3925 goto bitop_builtin;
3926 /* __builtin_ctz* return [0, prec-1], except for
3927 when the argument is 0, but that is undefined behavior.
3928 If there is a ctz optab for this mode and
3929 CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO, include that in the range,
3930 otherwise just assume 0 won't be seen. */
3931 CASE_CFN_CTZ:
3932 arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3933 prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (arg));
3934 mini = 0;
3935 maxi = prec - 1;
3936 if (optab_handler (ctz_optab, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)))
3937 != CODE_FOR_nothing
3938 && CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)),
3939 zerov))
3941 /* Handle only the two common values. */
3942 if (zerov == -1)
3943 mini = -1;
3944 else if (zerov == prec)
3945 maxi = prec;
3946 else
3947 /* Magic value to give up, unless vr0 proves
3948 arg is non-zero. */
3949 mini = -2;
3951 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
3953 value_range *vr0 = get_value_range (arg);
3954 /* If arg is non-zero, then use [0, prec - 1]. */
3955 if (((vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3956 && integer_nonzerop (vr0->min))
3957 || (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3958 && integer_zerop (vr0->min)))
3959 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->min))
3961 mini = 0;
3962 maxi = prec - 1;
3964 /* If some high bits are known to be zero,
3965 we can decrease the result maximum. */
3966 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE
3967 && TREE_CODE (vr0->max) == INTEGER_CST
3968 && !is_overflow_infinity (vr0->max))
3970 maxi = tree_floor_log2 (vr0->max);
3971 /* For vr0 [0, 0] give up. */
3972 if (maxi == -1)
3973 break;
3976 if (mini == -2)
3977 break;
3978 goto bitop_builtin;
3979 /* __builtin_clrsb* returns [0, prec-1]. */
3980 CASE_CFN_CLRSB:
3981 arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3982 prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (arg));
3983 mini = 0;
3984 maxi = prec - 1;
3985 goto bitop_builtin;
3986 bitop_builtin:
3987 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, build_int_cst (type, mini),
3988 build_int_cst (type, maxi), NULL);
3989 return;
3990 case CFN_UBSAN_CHECK_ADD:
3991 subcode = PLUS_EXPR;
3992 break;
3993 case CFN_UBSAN_CHECK_SUB:
3994 subcode = MINUS_EXPR;
3995 break;
3996 case CFN_UBSAN_CHECK_MUL:
3997 subcode = MULT_EXPR;
3998 break;
3999 case CFN_GOACC_DIM_SIZE:
4000 case CFN_GOACC_DIM_POS:
4001 /* Optimizing these two internal functions helps the loop
4002 optimizer eliminate outer comparisons. Size is [1,N]
4003 and pos is [0,N-1]. */
4005 bool is_pos = cfn == CFN_GOACC_DIM_POS;
4006 int axis = oacc_get_ifn_dim_arg (stmt);
4007 int size = oacc_get_fn_dim_size (current_function_decl, axis);
4009 if (!size)
4010 /* If it's dynamic, the backend might know a hardware
4011 limitation. */
4012 size = targetm.goacc.dim_limit (axis);
4014 tree type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_call_lhs (stmt));
4015 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE,
4016 build_int_cst (type, is_pos ? 0 : 1),
4017 size ? build_int_cst (type, size - is_pos)
4018 : vrp_val_max (type), NULL);
4020 return;
4021 case CFN_BUILT_IN_STRLEN:
4022 if (tree lhs = gimple_call_lhs (stmt))
4023 if (ptrdiff_type_node
4024 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ptrdiff_type_node)
4025 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (lhs))))
4027 tree type = TREE_TYPE (lhs);
4028 tree max = vrp_val_max (ptrdiff_type_node);
4029 wide_int wmax = wi::to_wide (max, TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (max)));
4030 tree range_min = build_zero_cst (type);
4031 tree range_max = wide_int_to_tree (type, wmax - 1);
4032 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, range_min, range_max, NULL);
4033 return;
4035 break;
4036 default:
4037 break;
4039 if (subcode != ERROR_MARK)
4041 bool saved_flag_wrapv = flag_wrapv;
4042 /* Pretend the arithmetics is wrapping. If there is
4043 any overflow, we'll complain, but will actually do
4044 wrapping operation. */
4045 flag_wrapv = 1;
4046 extract_range_from_binary_expr (vr, subcode, type,
4047 gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0),
4048 gimple_call_arg (stmt, 1));
4049 flag_wrapv = saved_flag_wrapv;
4051 /* If for both arguments vrp_valueize returned non-NULL,
4052 this should have been already folded and if not, it
4053 wasn't folded because of overflow. Avoid removing the
4054 UBSAN_CHECK_* calls in that case. */
4055 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
4056 && (vr->min == vr->max
4057 || operand_equal_p (vr->min, vr->max, 0)))
4058 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
4059 return;
4062 /* Handle extraction of the two results (result of arithmetics and
4063 a flag whether arithmetics overflowed) from {ADD,SUB,MUL}_OVERFLOW
4064 internal function. */
4065 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
4066 && (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == REALPART_EXPR
4067 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == IMAGPART_EXPR)
4068 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
4070 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
4071 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
4072 if (TREE_CODE (op) == code && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (op, 0)) == SSA_NAME)
4074 gimple *g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (TREE_OPERAND (op, 0));
4075 if (is_gimple_call (g) && gimple_call_internal_p (g))
4077 enum tree_code subcode = ERROR_MARK;
4078 switch (gimple_call_internal_fn (g))
4080 case IFN_ADD_OVERFLOW:
4081 subcode = PLUS_EXPR;
4082 break;
4083 case IFN_SUB_OVERFLOW:
4084 subcode = MINUS_EXPR;
4085 break;
4086 case IFN_MUL_OVERFLOW:
4087 subcode = MULT_EXPR;
4088 break;
4089 default:
4090 break;
4092 if (subcode != ERROR_MARK)
4094 tree op0 = gimple_call_arg (g, 0);
4095 tree op1 = gimple_call_arg (g, 1);
4096 if (code == IMAGPART_EXPR)
4098 bool ovf = false;
4099 if (check_for_binary_op_overflow (subcode, type,
4100 op0, op1, &ovf))
4101 set_value_range_to_value (vr,
4102 build_int_cst (type, ovf),
4103 NULL);
4104 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1
4105 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
4106 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
4107 else
4108 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, build_int_cst (type, 0),
4109 build_int_cst (type, 1), NULL);
4111 else if (types_compatible_p (type, TREE_TYPE (op0))
4112 && types_compatible_p (type, TREE_TYPE (op1)))
4114 bool saved_flag_wrapv = flag_wrapv;
4115 /* Pretend the arithmetics is wrapping. If there is
4116 any overflow, IMAGPART_EXPR will be set. */
4117 flag_wrapv = 1;
4118 extract_range_from_binary_expr (vr, subcode, type,
4119 op0, op1);
4120 flag_wrapv = saved_flag_wrapv;
4122 else
4124 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
4125 value_range vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
4126 bool saved_flag_wrapv = flag_wrapv;
4127 /* Pretend the arithmetics is wrapping. If there is
4128 any overflow, IMAGPART_EXPR will be set. */
4129 flag_wrapv = 1;
4130 extract_range_from_unary_expr (&vr0, NOP_EXPR,
4131 type, op0);
4132 extract_range_from_unary_expr (&vr1, NOP_EXPR,
4133 type, op1);
4134 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, subcode, type,
4135 &vr0, &vr1);
4136 flag_wrapv = saved_flag_wrapv;
4138 return;
4143 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
4144 && gimple_stmt_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt, &sop))
4145 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (vr, type,
4146 sop || stmt_overflow_infinity (stmt));
4147 else if (vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (stmt, &sop)
4148 && !sop)
4149 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, type);
4150 else
4151 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
4155 /* Try to compute a useful range out of assignment STMT and store it
4156 in *VR. */
4158 static void
4159 extract_range_from_assignment (value_range *vr, gassign *stmt)
4161 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
4163 if (code == ASSERT_EXPR)
4164 extract_range_from_assert (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
4165 else if (code == SSA_NAME)
4166 extract_range_from_ssa_name (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
4167 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary)
4168 extract_range_from_binary_expr (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
4169 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
4170 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
4171 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt));
4172 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary)
4173 extract_range_from_unary_expr (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
4174 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
4175 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
4176 else if (code == COND_EXPR)
4177 extract_range_from_cond_expr (vr, stmt);
4178 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison)
4179 extract_range_from_comparison (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
4180 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
4181 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
4182 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt));
4183 else if (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
4184 && is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
4185 set_value_range_to_value (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt), NULL);
4186 else
4187 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
4189 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING)
4190 extract_range_basic (vr, stmt);
4193 /* Given a range VR, a LOOP and a variable VAR, determine whether it
4194 would be profitable to adjust VR using scalar evolution information
4195 for VAR. If so, update VR with the new limits. */
4197 static void
4198 adjust_range_with_scev (value_range *vr, struct loop *loop,
4199 gimple *stmt, tree var)
4201 tree init, step, chrec, tmin, tmax, min, max, type, tem;
4202 enum ev_direction dir;
4204 /* TODO. Don't adjust anti-ranges. An anti-range may provide
4205 better opportunities than a regular range, but I'm not sure. */
4206 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4207 return;
4209 chrec = instantiate_parameters (loop, analyze_scalar_evolution (loop, var));
4211 /* Like in PR19590, scev can return a constant function. */
4212 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (chrec))
4214 set_value_range_to_value (vr, chrec, vr->equiv);
4215 return;
4218 if (TREE_CODE (chrec) != POLYNOMIAL_CHREC)
4219 return;
4221 init = initial_condition_in_loop_num (chrec, loop->num);
4222 tem = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (init);
4223 if (tem)
4224 init = tem;
4225 step = evolution_part_in_loop_num (chrec, loop->num);
4226 tem = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (step);
4227 if (tem)
4228 step = tem;
4230 /* If STEP is symbolic, we can't know whether INIT will be the
4231 minimum or maximum value in the range. Also, unless INIT is
4232 a simple expression, compare_values and possibly other functions
4233 in tree-vrp won't be able to handle it. */
4234 if (step == NULL_TREE
4235 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (step)
4236 || !valid_value_p (init))
4237 return;
4239 dir = scev_direction (chrec);
4240 if (/* Do not adjust ranges if we do not know whether the iv increases
4241 or decreases, ... */
4242 dir == EV_DIR_UNKNOWN
4243 /* ... or if it may wrap. */
4244 || scev_probably_wraps_p (NULL_TREE, init, step, stmt,
4245 get_chrec_loop (chrec), true))
4246 return;
4248 /* We use TYPE_MIN_VALUE and TYPE_MAX_VALUE here instead of
4249 negative_overflow_infinity and positive_overflow_infinity,
4250 because we have concluded that the loop probably does not
4251 wrap. */
4253 type = TREE_TYPE (var);
4254 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) || !TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type))
4255 tmin = lower_bound_in_type (type, type);
4256 else
4257 tmin = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
4258 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) || !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type))
4259 tmax = upper_bound_in_type (type, type);
4260 else
4261 tmax = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
4263 /* Try to use estimated number of iterations for the loop to constrain the
4264 final value in the evolution. */
4265 if (TREE_CODE (step) == INTEGER_CST
4266 && is_gimple_val (init)
4267 && (TREE_CODE (init) != SSA_NAME
4268 || get_value_range (init)->type == VR_RANGE))
4270 widest_int nit;
4272 /* We are only entering here for loop header PHI nodes, so using
4273 the number of latch executions is the correct thing to use. */
4274 if (max_loop_iterations (loop, &nit))
4276 value_range maxvr = VR_INITIALIZER;
4277 signop sgn = TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (step));
4278 bool overflow;
4280 widest_int wtmp = wi::mul (wi::to_widest (step), nit, sgn,
4281 &overflow);
4282 /* If the multiplication overflowed we can't do a meaningful
4283 adjustment. Likewise if the result doesn't fit in the type
4284 of the induction variable. For a signed type we have to
4285 check whether the result has the expected signedness which
4286 is that of the step as number of iterations is unsigned. */
4287 if (!overflow
4288 && wi::fits_to_tree_p (wtmp, TREE_TYPE (init))
4289 && (sgn == UNSIGNED
4290 || wi::gts_p (wtmp, 0) == wi::gts_p (step, 0)))
4292 tem = wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (init), wtmp);
4293 extract_range_from_binary_expr (&maxvr, PLUS_EXPR,
4294 TREE_TYPE (init), init, tem);
4295 /* Likewise if the addition did. */
4296 if (maxvr.type == VR_RANGE)
4298 value_range initvr = VR_INITIALIZER;
4300 if (TREE_CODE (init) == SSA_NAME)
4301 initvr = *(get_value_range (init));
4302 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (init))
4303 set_value_range_to_value (&initvr, init, NULL);
4304 else
4305 return;
4307 /* Check if init + nit * step overflows. Though we checked
4308 scev {init, step}_loop doesn't wrap, it is not enough
4309 because the loop may exit immediately. Overflow could
4310 happen in the plus expression in this case. */
4311 if ((dir == EV_DIR_DECREASES
4312 && (is_negative_overflow_infinity (maxvr.min)
4313 || compare_values (maxvr.min, initvr.min) != -1))
4314 || (dir == EV_DIR_GROWS
4315 && (is_positive_overflow_infinity (maxvr.max)
4316 || compare_values (maxvr.max, initvr.max) != 1)))
4317 return;
4319 tmin = maxvr.min;
4320 tmax = maxvr.max;
4326 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING || vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4328 min = tmin;
4329 max = tmax;
4331 /* For VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges, just about anything we get
4332 from scalar evolutions should be better. */
4334 if (dir == EV_DIR_DECREASES)
4335 max = init;
4336 else
4337 min = init;
4339 else if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
4341 min = vr->min;
4342 max = vr->max;
4344 if (dir == EV_DIR_DECREASES)
4346 /* INIT is the maximum value. If INIT is lower than VR->MAX
4347 but no smaller than VR->MIN, set VR->MAX to INIT. */
4348 if (compare_values (init, max) == -1)
4349 max = init;
4351 /* According to the loop information, the variable does not
4352 overflow. If we think it does, probably because of an
4353 overflow due to arithmetic on a different INF value,
4354 reset now. */
4355 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (min)
4356 || compare_values (min, tmin) == -1)
4357 min = tmin;
4360 else
4362 /* If INIT is bigger than VR->MIN, set VR->MIN to INIT. */
4363 if (compare_values (init, min) == 1)
4364 min = init;
4366 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (max)
4367 || compare_values (tmax, max) == -1)
4368 max = tmax;
4371 else
4372 return;
4374 /* If we just created an invalid range with the minimum
4375 greater than the maximum, we fail conservatively.
4376 This should happen only in unreachable
4377 parts of code, or for invalid programs. */
4378 if (compare_values (min, max) == 1
4379 || (is_negative_overflow_infinity (min)
4380 && is_positive_overflow_infinity (max)))
4381 return;
4383 /* Even for valid range info, sometimes overflow flag will leak in.
4384 As GIMPLE IL should have no constants with TREE_OVERFLOW set, we
4385 drop them except for +-overflow_infinity which still need special
4386 handling in vrp pass. */
4387 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (min)
4388 && ! is_negative_overflow_infinity (min))
4389 min = drop_tree_overflow (min);
4390 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (max)
4391 && ! is_positive_overflow_infinity (max))
4392 max = drop_tree_overflow (max);
4394 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr->equiv);
4398 /* Given two numeric value ranges VR0, VR1 and a comparison code COMP:
4400 - Return BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR0 COMP VR1 always returns true for
4401 all the values in the ranges.
4403 - Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison always returns false.
4405 - Return NULL_TREE if it is not always possible to determine the
4406 value of the comparison.
4408 Also set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an
4409 overflow infinity was used in the test. */
4412 static tree
4413 compare_ranges (enum tree_code comp, value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1,
4414 bool *strict_overflow_p)
4416 /* VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges cannot be compared. */
4417 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING
4418 || vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED
4419 || vr1->type == VR_VARYING
4420 || vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4421 return NULL_TREE;
4423 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
4424 if (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE || vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4426 /* If both are anti-ranges, then we cannot compute any
4427 comparison. */
4428 if (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE && vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4429 return NULL_TREE;
4431 /* These comparisons are never statically computable. */
4432 if (comp == GT_EXPR
4433 || comp == GE_EXPR
4434 || comp == LT_EXPR
4435 || comp == LE_EXPR)
4436 return NULL_TREE;
4438 /* Equality can be computed only between a range and an
4439 anti-range. ~[VAL1, VAL2] == [VAL1, VAL2] is always false. */
4440 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE)
4442 /* To simplify processing, make VR0 the anti-range. */
4443 value_range *tmp = vr0;
4444 vr0 = vr1;
4445 vr1 = tmp;
4448 gcc_assert (comp == NE_EXPR || comp == EQ_EXPR);
4450 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p) == 0
4451 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4452 return (comp == NE_EXPR) ? boolean_true_node : boolean_false_node;
4454 return NULL_TREE;
4457 if (!usable_range_p (vr0, strict_overflow_p)
4458 || !usable_range_p (vr1, strict_overflow_p))
4459 return NULL_TREE;
4461 /* Simplify processing. If COMP is GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR, switch the
4462 operands around and change the comparison code. */
4463 if (comp == GT_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR)
4465 comp = (comp == GT_EXPR) ? LT_EXPR : LE_EXPR;
4466 std::swap (vr0, vr1);
4469 if (comp == EQ_EXPR)
4471 /* Equality may only be computed if both ranges represent
4472 exactly one value. */
4473 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr0->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0
4474 && compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4476 int cmp_min = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min,
4477 strict_overflow_p);
4478 int cmp_max = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max,
4479 strict_overflow_p);
4480 if (cmp_min == 0 && cmp_max == 0)
4481 return boolean_true_node;
4482 else if (cmp_min != -2 && cmp_max != -2)
4483 return boolean_false_node;
4485 /* If [V0_MIN, V1_MAX] < [V1_MIN, V1_MAX] then V0 != V1. */
4486 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max,
4487 strict_overflow_p) == 1
4488 || compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr0->max,
4489 strict_overflow_p) == 1)
4490 return boolean_false_node;
4492 return NULL_TREE;
4494 else if (comp == NE_EXPR)
4496 int cmp1, cmp2;
4498 /* If VR0 is completely to the left or completely to the right
4499 of VR1, they are always different. Notice that we need to
4500 make sure that both comparisons yield similar results to
4501 avoid comparing values that cannot be compared at
4502 compile-time. */
4503 cmp1 = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p);
4504 cmp2 = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p);
4505 if ((cmp1 == -1 && cmp2 == -1) || (cmp1 == 1 && cmp2 == 1))
4506 return boolean_true_node;
4508 /* If VR0 and VR1 represent a single value and are identical,
4509 return false. */
4510 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr0->max,
4511 strict_overflow_p) == 0
4512 && compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr1->max,
4513 strict_overflow_p) == 0
4514 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min,
4515 strict_overflow_p) == 0
4516 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max,
4517 strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4518 return boolean_false_node;
4520 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
4521 else
4522 return NULL_TREE;
4524 else if (comp == LT_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
4526 int tst;
4528 /* If VR0 is to the left of VR1, return true. */
4529 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p);
4530 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && tst == -1)
4531 || (comp == LE_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0)))
4533 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0)
4534 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1))
4535 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4536 return boolean_true_node;
4539 /* If VR0 is to the right of VR1, return false. */
4540 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p);
4541 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1))
4542 || (comp == LE_EXPR && tst == 1))
4544 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0)
4545 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1))
4546 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4547 return boolean_false_node;
4550 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4551 return NULL_TREE;
4554 gcc_unreachable ();
4558 /* Given a value range VR, a value VAL and a comparison code COMP, return
4559 BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR COMP VAL always returns true for all the
4560 values in VR. Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison
4561 always returns false. Return NULL_TREE if it is not always
4562 possible to determine the value of the comparison. Also set
4563 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an overflow
4564 infinity was used in the test. */
4566 static tree
4567 compare_range_with_value (enum tree_code comp, value_range *vr, tree val,
4568 bool *strict_overflow_p)
4570 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING || vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4571 return NULL_TREE;
4573 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
4574 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4576 /* For anti-ranges, the only predicates that we can compute at
4577 compile time are equality and inequality. */
4578 if (comp == GT_EXPR
4579 || comp == GE_EXPR
4580 || comp == LT_EXPR
4581 || comp == LE_EXPR)
4582 return NULL_TREE;
4584 /* ~[VAL_1, VAL_2] OP VAL is known if VAL_1 <= VAL <= VAL_2. */
4585 if (value_inside_range (val, vr->min, vr->max) == 1)
4586 return (comp == NE_EXPR) ? boolean_true_node : boolean_false_node;
4588 return NULL_TREE;
4591 if (!usable_range_p (vr, strict_overflow_p))
4592 return NULL_TREE;
4594 if (comp == EQ_EXPR)
4596 /* EQ_EXPR may only be computed if VR represents exactly
4597 one value. */
4598 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->min, vr->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4600 int cmp = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4601 if (cmp == 0)
4602 return boolean_true_node;
4603 else if (cmp == -1 || cmp == 1 || cmp == 2)
4604 return boolean_false_node;
4606 else if (compare_values_warnv (val, vr->min, strict_overflow_p) == -1
4607 || compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p) == -1)
4608 return boolean_false_node;
4610 return NULL_TREE;
4612 else if (comp == NE_EXPR)
4614 /* If VAL is not inside VR, then they are always different. */
4615 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p) == -1
4616 || compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p) == 1)
4617 return boolean_true_node;
4619 /* If VR represents exactly one value equal to VAL, then return
4620 false. */
4621 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->min, vr->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0
4622 && compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4623 return boolean_false_node;
4625 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
4626 return NULL_TREE;
4628 else if (comp == LT_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
4630 int tst;
4632 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return true. */
4633 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p);
4634 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && tst == -1)
4635 || (comp == LE_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0)))
4637 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4638 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4639 return boolean_true_node;
4642 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return false. */
4643 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4644 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1))
4645 || (comp == LE_EXPR && tst == 1))
4647 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4648 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4649 return boolean_false_node;
4652 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4653 return NULL_TREE;
4655 else if (comp == GT_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR)
4657 int tst;
4659 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return true. */
4660 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4661 if ((comp == GT_EXPR && tst == 1)
4662 || (comp == GE_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1)))
4664 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4665 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4666 return boolean_true_node;
4669 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return false. */
4670 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p);
4671 if ((comp == GT_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0))
4672 || (comp == GE_EXPR && tst == -1))
4674 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4675 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4676 return boolean_false_node;
4679 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4680 return NULL_TREE;
4683 gcc_unreachable ();
4687 /* Debugging dumps. */
4689 void dump_value_range (FILE *, const value_range *);
4690 void debug_value_range (value_range *);
4691 void dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *);
4692 void debug_all_value_ranges (void);
4693 void dump_vr_equiv (FILE *, bitmap);
4694 void debug_vr_equiv (bitmap);
4697 /* Dump value range VR to FILE. */
4699 void
4700 dump_value_range (FILE *file, const value_range *vr)
4702 if (vr == NULL)
4703 fprintf (file, "[]");
4704 else if (vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4705 fprintf (file, "UNDEFINED");
4706 else if (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4708 tree type = TREE_TYPE (vr->min);
4710 fprintf (file, "%s[", (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE) ? "~" : "");
4712 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr->min))
4713 fprintf (file, "-INF(OVF)");
4714 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
4715 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
4716 && vrp_val_is_min (vr->min))
4717 fprintf (file, "-INF");
4718 else
4719 print_generic_expr (file, vr->min, 0);
4721 fprintf (file, ", ");
4723 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
4724 fprintf (file, "+INF(OVF)");
4725 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
4726 && vrp_val_is_max (vr->max))
4727 fprintf (file, "+INF");
4728 else
4729 print_generic_expr (file, vr->max, 0);
4731 fprintf (file, "]");
4733 if (vr->equiv)
4735 bitmap_iterator bi;
4736 unsigned i, c = 0;
4738 fprintf (file, " EQUIVALENCES: { ");
4740 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (vr->equiv, 0, i, bi)
4742 print_generic_expr (file, ssa_name (i), 0);
4743 fprintf (file, " ");
4744 c++;
4747 fprintf (file, "} (%u elements)", c);
4750 else if (vr->type == VR_VARYING)
4751 fprintf (file, "VARYING");
4752 else
4753 fprintf (file, "INVALID RANGE");
4757 /* Dump value range VR to stderr. */
4759 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4760 debug_value_range (value_range *vr)
4762 dump_value_range (stderr, vr);
4763 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
4767 /* Dump value ranges of all SSA_NAMEs to FILE. */
4769 void
4770 dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *file)
4772 size_t i;
4774 for (i = 0; i < num_vr_values; i++)
4776 if (vr_value[i])
4778 print_generic_expr (file, ssa_name (i), 0);
4779 fprintf (file, ": ");
4780 dump_value_range (file, vr_value[i]);
4781 fprintf (file, "\n");
4785 fprintf (file, "\n");
4789 /* Dump all value ranges to stderr. */
4791 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4792 debug_all_value_ranges (void)
4794 dump_all_value_ranges (stderr);
4798 /* Given a COND_EXPR COND of the form 'V OP W', and an SSA name V,
4799 create a new SSA name N and return the assertion assignment
4800 'N = ASSERT_EXPR <V, V OP W>'. */
4802 static gimple *
4803 build_assert_expr_for (tree cond, tree v)
4805 tree a;
4806 gassign *assertion;
4808 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (v) == SSA_NAME
4809 && COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond));
4811 a = build2 (ASSERT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (v), v, cond);
4812 assertion = gimple_build_assign (NULL_TREE, a);
4814 /* The new ASSERT_EXPR, creates a new SSA name that replaces the
4815 operand of the ASSERT_EXPR. Create it so the new name and the old one
4816 are registered in the replacement table so that we can fix the SSA web
4817 after adding all the ASSERT_EXPRs. */
4818 create_new_def_for (v, assertion, NULL);
4820 return assertion;
4824 /* Return false if EXPR is a predicate expression involving floating
4825 point values. */
4827 static inline bool
4828 fp_predicate (gimple *stmt)
4830 GIMPLE_CHECK (stmt, GIMPLE_COND);
4832 return FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt)));
4835 /* If the range of values taken by OP can be inferred after STMT executes,
4836 return the comparison code (COMP_CODE_P) and value (VAL_P) that
4837 describes the inferred range. Return true if a range could be
4838 inferred. */
4840 static bool
4841 infer_value_range (gimple *stmt, tree op, tree_code *comp_code_p, tree *val_p)
4843 *val_p = NULL_TREE;
4844 *comp_code_p = ERROR_MARK;
4846 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
4847 abnormal edges. */
4848 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (op))
4849 return false;
4851 /* If STMT is the last statement of a basic block with no normal
4852 successors, there is no point inferring anything about any of its
4853 operands. We would not be able to find a proper insertion point
4854 for the assertion, anyway. */
4855 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt))
4857 edge_iterator ei;
4858 edge e;
4860 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, gimple_bb (stmt)->succs)
4861 if (!(e->flags & (EDGE_ABNORMAL|EDGE_EH)))
4862 break;
4863 if (e == NULL)
4864 return false;
4867 if (infer_nonnull_range (stmt, op))
4869 *val_p = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op), 0);
4870 *comp_code_p = NE_EXPR;
4871 return true;
4874 return false;
4878 void dump_asserts_for (FILE *, tree);
4879 void debug_asserts_for (tree);
4880 void dump_all_asserts (FILE *);
4881 void debug_all_asserts (void);
4883 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to FILE. */
4885 void
4886 dump_asserts_for (FILE *file, tree name)
4888 assert_locus *loc;
4890 fprintf (file, "Assertions to be inserted for ");
4891 print_generic_expr (file, name, 0);
4892 fprintf (file, "\n");
4894 loc = asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)];
4895 while (loc)
4897 fprintf (file, "\t");
4898 print_gimple_stmt (file, gsi_stmt (loc->si), 0, 0);
4899 fprintf (file, "\n\tBB #%d", loc->bb->index);
4900 if (loc->e)
4902 fprintf (file, "\n\tEDGE %d->%d", loc->e->src->index,
4903 loc->e->dest->index);
4904 dump_edge_info (file, loc->e, dump_flags, 0);
4906 fprintf (file, "\n\tPREDICATE: ");
4907 print_generic_expr (file, loc->expr, 0);
4908 fprintf (file, " %s ", get_tree_code_name (loc->comp_code));
4909 print_generic_expr (file, loc->val, 0);
4910 fprintf (file, "\n\n");
4911 loc = loc->next;
4914 fprintf (file, "\n");
4918 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to stderr. */
4920 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4921 debug_asserts_for (tree name)
4923 dump_asserts_for (stderr, name);
4927 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to FILE. */
4929 void
4930 dump_all_asserts (FILE *file)
4932 unsigned i;
4933 bitmap_iterator bi;
4935 fprintf (file, "\nASSERT_EXPRs to be inserted\n\n");
4936 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for, 0, i, bi)
4937 dump_asserts_for (file, ssa_name (i));
4938 fprintf (file, "\n");
4942 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to stderr. */
4944 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4945 debug_all_asserts (void)
4947 dump_all_asserts (stderr);
4951 /* If NAME doesn't have an ASSERT_EXPR registered for asserting
4952 'EXPR COMP_CODE VAL' at a location that dominates block BB or
4953 E->DEST, then register this location as a possible insertion point
4954 for ASSERT_EXPR <NAME, EXPR COMP_CODE VAL>.
4956 BB, E and SI provide the exact insertion point for the new
4957 ASSERT_EXPR. If BB is NULL, then the ASSERT_EXPR is to be inserted
4958 on edge E. Otherwise, if E is NULL, the ASSERT_EXPR is inserted on
4959 BB. If SI points to a COND_EXPR or a SWITCH_EXPR statement, then E
4960 must not be NULL. */
4962 static void
4963 register_new_assert_for (tree name, tree expr,
4964 enum tree_code comp_code,
4965 tree val,
4966 basic_block bb,
4967 edge e,
4968 gimple_stmt_iterator si)
4970 assert_locus *n, *loc, *last_loc;
4971 basic_block dest_bb;
4973 gcc_checking_assert (bb == NULL || e == NULL);
4975 if (e == NULL)
4976 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si)) != GIMPLE_COND
4977 && gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si)) != GIMPLE_SWITCH);
4979 /* Never build an assert comparing against an integer constant with
4980 TREE_OVERFLOW set. This confuses our undefined overflow warning
4981 machinery. */
4982 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (val))
4983 val = drop_tree_overflow (val);
4985 /* The new assertion A will be inserted at BB or E. We need to
4986 determine if the new location is dominated by a previously
4987 registered location for A. If we are doing an edge insertion,
4988 assume that A will be inserted at E->DEST. Note that this is not
4989 necessarily true.
4991 If E is a critical edge, it will be split. But even if E is
4992 split, the new block will dominate the same set of blocks that
4993 E->DEST dominates.
4995 The reverse, however, is not true, blocks dominated by E->DEST
4996 will not be dominated by the new block created to split E. So,
4997 if the insertion location is on a critical edge, we will not use
4998 the new location to move another assertion previously registered
4999 at a block dominated by E->DEST. */
5000 dest_bb = (bb) ? bb : e->dest;
5002 /* If NAME already has an ASSERT_EXPR registered for COMP_CODE and
5003 VAL at a block dominating DEST_BB, then we don't need to insert a new
5004 one. Similarly, if the same assertion already exists at a block
5005 dominated by DEST_BB and the new location is not on a critical
5006 edge, then update the existing location for the assertion (i.e.,
5007 move the assertion up in the dominance tree).
5009 Note, this is implemented as a simple linked list because there
5010 should not be more than a handful of assertions registered per
5011 name. If this becomes a performance problem, a table hashed by
5012 COMP_CODE and VAL could be implemented. */
5013 loc = asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)];
5014 last_loc = loc;
5015 while (loc)
5017 if (loc->comp_code == comp_code
5018 && (loc->val == val
5019 || operand_equal_p (loc->val, val, 0))
5020 && (loc->expr == expr
5021 || operand_equal_p (loc->expr, expr, 0)))
5023 /* If E is not a critical edge and DEST_BB
5024 dominates the existing location for the assertion, move
5025 the assertion up in the dominance tree by updating its
5026 location information. */
5027 if ((e == NULL || !EDGE_CRITICAL_P (e))
5028 && dominated_by_p (CDI_DOMINATORS, loc->bb, dest_bb))
5030 loc->bb = dest_bb;
5031 loc->e = e;
5032 loc->si = si;
5033 return;
5037 /* Update the last node of the list and move to the next one. */
5038 last_loc = loc;
5039 loc = loc->next;
5042 /* If we didn't find an assertion already registered for
5043 NAME COMP_CODE VAL, add a new one at the end of the list of
5044 assertions associated with NAME. */
5045 n = XNEW (struct assert_locus);
5046 n->bb = dest_bb;
5047 n->e = e;
5048 n->si = si;
5049 n->comp_code = comp_code;
5050 n->val = val;
5051 n->expr = expr;
5052 n->next = NULL;
5054 if (last_loc)
5055 last_loc->next = n;
5056 else
5057 asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)] = n;
5059 bitmap_set_bit (need_assert_for, SSA_NAME_VERSION (name));
5062 /* (COND_OP0 COND_CODE COND_OP1) is a predicate which uses NAME.
5063 Extract a suitable test code and value and store them into *CODE_P and
5064 *VAL_P so the predicate is normalized to NAME *CODE_P *VAL_P.
5066 If no extraction was possible, return FALSE, otherwise return TRUE.
5068 If INVERT is true, then we invert the result stored into *CODE_P. */
5070 static bool
5071 extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (tree name, enum tree_code cond_code,
5072 tree cond_op0, tree cond_op1,
5073 bool invert, enum tree_code *code_p,
5074 tree *val_p)
5076 enum tree_code comp_code;
5077 tree val;
5079 /* Otherwise, we have a comparison of the form NAME COMP VAL
5080 or VAL COMP NAME. */
5081 if (name == cond_op1)
5083 /* If the predicate is of the form VAL COMP NAME, flip
5084 COMP around because we need to register NAME as the
5085 first operand in the predicate. */
5086 comp_code = swap_tree_comparison (cond_code);
5087 val = cond_op0;
5089 else if (name == cond_op0)
5091 /* The comparison is of the form NAME COMP VAL, so the
5092 comparison code remains unchanged. */
5093 comp_code = cond_code;
5094 val = cond_op1;
5096 else
5097 gcc_unreachable ();
5099 /* Invert the comparison code as necessary. */
5100 if (invert)
5101 comp_code = invert_tree_comparison (comp_code, 0);
5103 /* VRP only handles integral and pointer types. */
5104 if (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val))
5105 && ! POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val)))
5106 return false;
5108 /* Do not register always-false predicates.
5109 FIXME: this works around a limitation in fold() when dealing with
5110 enumerations. Given 'enum { N1, N2 } x;', fold will not
5111 fold 'if (x > N2)' to 'if (0)'. */
5112 if ((comp_code == GT_EXPR || comp_code == LT_EXPR)
5113 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val)))
5115 tree min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
5116 tree max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
5118 if (comp_code == GT_EXPR
5119 && (!max
5120 || compare_values (val, max) == 0))
5121 return false;
5123 if (comp_code == LT_EXPR
5124 && (!min
5125 || compare_values (val, min) == 0))
5126 return false;
5128 *code_p = comp_code;
5129 *val_p = val;
5130 return true;
5133 /* Find out smallest RES where RES > VAL && (RES & MASK) == RES, if any
5134 (otherwise return VAL). VAL and MASK must be zero-extended for
5135 precision PREC. If SGNBIT is non-zero, first xor VAL with SGNBIT
5136 (to transform signed values into unsigned) and at the end xor
5137 SGNBIT back. */
5139 static wide_int
5140 masked_increment (const wide_int &val_in, const wide_int &mask,
5141 const wide_int &sgnbit, unsigned int prec)
5143 wide_int bit = wi::one (prec), res;
5144 unsigned int i;
5146 wide_int val = val_in ^ sgnbit;
5147 for (i = 0; i < prec; i++, bit += bit)
5149 res = mask;
5150 if ((res & bit) == 0)
5151 continue;
5152 res = bit - 1;
5153 res = (val + bit).and_not (res);
5154 res &= mask;
5155 if (wi::gtu_p (res, val))
5156 return res ^ sgnbit;
5158 return val ^ sgnbit;
5161 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
5162 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by BSI.
5163 Invert the condition COND if INVERT is true. */
5165 static void
5166 register_edge_assert_for_2 (tree name, edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi,
5167 enum tree_code cond_code,
5168 tree cond_op0, tree cond_op1, bool invert)
5170 tree val;
5171 enum tree_code comp_code;
5173 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name, cond_code,
5174 cond_op0,
5175 cond_op1,
5176 invert, &comp_code, &val))
5177 return;
5179 /* Only register an ASSERT_EXPR if NAME was found in the sub-graph
5180 reachable from E. */
5181 if (live_on_edge (e, name))
5182 register_new_assert_for (name, name, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
5184 /* In the case of NAME <= CST and NAME being defined as
5185 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2 + CST2 we can assert NAME2 >= -CST2
5186 and NAME2 <= CST - CST2. We can do the same for NAME > CST.
5187 This catches range and anti-range tests. */
5188 if ((comp_code == LE_EXPR
5189 || comp_code == GT_EXPR)
5190 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST
5191 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
5193 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5194 tree cst2 = NULL_TREE, name2 = NULL_TREE, name3 = NULL_TREE;
5196 /* Extract CST2 from the (optional) addition. */
5197 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5198 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == PLUS_EXPR)
5200 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5201 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5202 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
5203 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST)
5204 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2);
5207 /* Extract NAME2 from the (optional) sign-changing cast. */
5208 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt))
5210 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt))
5211 && ! TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))
5212 && (TYPE_PRECISION (gimple_expr_type (def_stmt))
5213 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))))
5214 name3 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5217 /* If name3 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
5218 if (name3 != NULL_TREE
5219 && TREE_CODE (name3) == SSA_NAME
5220 && (cst2 == NULL_TREE
5221 || TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST)
5222 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name3))
5223 && live_on_edge (e, name3))
5225 tree tmp;
5227 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
5228 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), name3);
5229 if (cst2 != NULL_TREE)
5230 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp, cst2);
5232 if (dump_file)
5234 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5235 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name3, 0);
5236 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5237 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5238 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5241 register_new_assert_for (name3, tmp, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
5244 /* If name2 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
5245 if (name2 != NULL_TREE
5246 && TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
5247 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST
5248 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5249 && live_on_edge (e, name2))
5251 tree tmp;
5253 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
5254 tmp = name2;
5255 if (TREE_TYPE (name) != TREE_TYPE (name2))
5256 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp);
5257 if (cst2 != NULL_TREE)
5258 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp, cst2);
5260 if (dump_file)
5262 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5263 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
5264 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5265 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5266 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5269 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
5273 /* In the case of post-in/decrement tests like if (i++) ... and uses
5274 of the in/decremented value on the edge the extra name we want to
5275 assert for is not on the def chain of the name compared. Instead
5276 it is in the set of use stmts.
5277 Similar cases happen for conversions that were simplified through
5278 fold_{sign_changed,widened}_comparison. */
5279 if ((comp_code == NE_EXPR
5280 || comp_code == EQ_EXPR)
5281 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST)
5283 imm_use_iterator ui;
5284 gimple *use_stmt;
5285 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt, ui, name)
5287 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt))
5288 continue;
5290 /* Cut off to use-stmts that are dominating the predecessor. */
5291 if (!dominated_by_p (CDI_DOMINATORS, e->src, gimple_bb (use_stmt)))
5292 continue;
5294 tree name2 = gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt);
5295 if (TREE_CODE (name2) != SSA_NAME
5296 || !live_on_edge (e, name2))
5297 continue;
5299 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt);
5300 tree cst;
5301 if (code == PLUS_EXPR
5302 || code == MINUS_EXPR)
5304 cst = gimple_assign_rhs2 (use_stmt);
5305 if (TREE_CODE (cst) != INTEGER_CST)
5306 continue;
5307 cst = int_const_binop (code, val, cst);
5309 else if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code))
5311 /* For truncating conversions we cannot record
5312 an inequality. */
5313 if (comp_code == NE_EXPR
5314 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5315 < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name))))
5316 continue;
5317 cst = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2), val);
5319 else
5320 continue;
5322 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (cst))
5323 cst = drop_tree_overflow (cst);
5324 register_new_assert_for (name2, name2, comp_code, cst,
5325 NULL, e, bsi);
5329 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (comp_code) == tcc_comparison
5330 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST)
5332 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5333 tree name2 = NULL_TREE, names[2], cst2 = NULL_TREE;
5334 tree val2 = NULL_TREE;
5335 unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (val));
5336 wide_int mask = wi::zero (prec);
5337 unsigned int nprec = prec;
5338 enum tree_code rhs_code = ERROR_MARK;
5340 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt))
5341 rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt);
5343 /* In the case of NAME != CST1 where NAME = A +- CST2 we can
5344 assert that A != CST1 -+ CST2. */
5345 if ((comp_code == EQ_EXPR || comp_code == NE_EXPR)
5346 && (rhs_code == PLUS_EXPR || rhs_code == MINUS_EXPR))
5348 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5349 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5350 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
5351 && TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST
5352 && live_on_edge (e, op0))
5354 enum tree_code reverse_op = (rhs_code == PLUS_EXPR
5355 ? MINUS_EXPR : PLUS_EXPR);
5356 op1 = int_const_binop (reverse_op, val, op1);
5357 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (op1))
5358 op1 = drop_tree_overflow (op1);
5359 register_new_assert_for (op0, op0, comp_code, op1, NULL, e, bsi);
5363 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined
5364 as NAME = (int) NAME2. */
5365 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))
5366 && (comp_code == LE_EXPR || comp_code == LT_EXPR
5367 || comp_code == GT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
5368 && gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt))
5370 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5371 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code)
5372 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5373 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5374 && prec == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5375 && (comp_code == LE_EXPR || comp_code == GT_EXPR
5376 || !tree_int_cst_equal (val,
5377 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val))))
5378 && live_on_edge (e, name2))
5380 tree tmp, cst;
5381 enum tree_code new_comp_code = comp_code;
5383 cst = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2),
5384 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val)));
5385 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
5386 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), name2, cst);
5387 cst = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), cst,
5388 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2), val));
5389 if (comp_code == LT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
5391 new_comp_code = comp_code == LT_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
5392 cst = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), cst,
5393 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (name2), 1));
5396 if (dump_file)
5398 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5399 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
5400 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5401 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5402 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5405 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, new_comp_code, cst, NULL,
5406 e, bsi);
5410 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
5411 NAME = NAME2 >> CST2.
5413 Extract CST2 from the right shift. */
5414 if (rhs_code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
5416 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5417 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5418 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
5419 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (cst2)
5420 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5421 && IN_RANGE (tree_to_uhwi (cst2), 1, prec - 1)
5422 && prec == GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (val)))
5423 && live_on_edge (e, name2))
5425 mask = wi::mask (tree_to_uhwi (cst2), false, prec);
5426 val2 = fold_binary (LSHIFT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (val), val, cst2);
5429 if (val2 != NULL_TREE
5430 && TREE_CODE (val2) == INTEGER_CST
5431 && simple_cst_equal (fold_build2 (RSHIFT_EXPR,
5432 TREE_TYPE (val),
5433 val2, cst2), val))
5435 enum tree_code new_comp_code = comp_code;
5436 tree tmp, new_val;
5438 tmp = name2;
5439 if (comp_code == EQ_EXPR || comp_code == NE_EXPR)
5441 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
5443 tree type = build_nonstandard_integer_type (prec, 1);
5444 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, type, name2);
5445 val2 = fold_convert (type, val2);
5447 tmp = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tmp), tmp, val2);
5448 new_val = wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (tmp), mask);
5449 new_comp_code = comp_code == EQ_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
5451 else if (comp_code == LT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
5453 wide_int minval
5454 = wi::min_value (prec, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (val)));
5455 new_val = val2;
5456 if (minval == new_val)
5457 new_val = NULL_TREE;
5459 else
5461 wide_int maxval
5462 = wi::max_value (prec, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (val)));
5463 mask |= val2;
5464 if (mask == maxval)
5465 new_val = NULL_TREE;
5466 else
5467 new_val = wide_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (val2), mask);
5470 if (new_val)
5472 if (dump_file)
5474 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5475 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
5476 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5477 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5478 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5481 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, new_comp_code, new_val,
5482 NULL, e, bsi);
5486 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
5487 NAME = NAME2 & CST2.
5489 Extract CST2 from the and.
5491 Also handle
5492 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2;
5493 casts where NAME's type is unsigned and has smaller precision
5494 than NAME2's type as if it was NAME = NAME2 & MASK. */
5495 names[0] = NULL_TREE;
5496 names[1] = NULL_TREE;
5497 cst2 = NULL_TREE;
5498 if (rhs_code == BIT_AND_EXPR
5499 || (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code)
5500 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val))
5501 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))
5502 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))
5503 > prec))
5505 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5506 if (rhs_code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
5507 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5508 else
5510 cst2 = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
5511 nprec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2));
5513 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
5514 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5515 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST
5516 && !integer_zerop (cst2)
5517 && (nprec > 1
5518 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))))
5520 gimple *def_stmt2 = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2);
5521 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt2))
5523 names[1] = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt2);
5524 if (!CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt2))
5525 || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (names[1]))
5526 || (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2))
5527 != TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (names[1])))
5528 || !live_on_edge (e, names[1]))
5529 names[1] = NULL_TREE;
5531 if (live_on_edge (e, name2))
5532 names[0] = name2;
5535 if (names[0] || names[1])
5537 wide_int minv, maxv, valv, cst2v;
5538 wide_int tem, sgnbit;
5539 bool valid_p = false, valn, cst2n;
5540 enum tree_code ccode = comp_code;
5542 valv = wide_int::from (val, nprec, UNSIGNED);
5543 cst2v = wide_int::from (cst2, nprec, UNSIGNED);
5544 valn = wi::neg_p (valv, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (val)));
5545 cst2n = wi::neg_p (cst2v, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (val)));
5546 /* If CST2 doesn't have most significant bit set,
5547 but VAL is negative, we have comparison like
5548 if ((x & 0x123) > -4) (always true). Just give up. */
5549 if (!cst2n && valn)
5550 ccode = ERROR_MARK;
5551 if (cst2n)
5552 sgnbit = wi::set_bit_in_zero (nprec - 1, nprec);
5553 else
5554 sgnbit = wi::zero (nprec);
5555 minv = valv & cst2v;
5556 switch (ccode)
5558 case EQ_EXPR:
5559 /* Minimum unsigned value for equality is VAL & CST2
5560 (should be equal to VAL, otherwise we probably should
5561 have folded the comparison into false) and
5562 maximum unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2. */
5563 maxv = valv | ~cst2v;
5564 valid_p = true;
5565 break;
5567 case NE_EXPR:
5568 tem = valv | ~cst2v;
5569 /* If VAL is 0, handle (X & CST2) != 0 as (X & CST2) > 0U. */
5570 if (valv == 0)
5572 cst2n = false;
5573 sgnbit = wi::zero (nprec);
5574 goto gt_expr;
5576 /* If (VAL | ~CST2) is all ones, handle it as
5577 (X & CST2) < VAL. */
5578 if (tem == -1)
5580 cst2n = false;
5581 valn = false;
5582 sgnbit = wi::zero (nprec);
5583 goto lt_expr;
5585 if (!cst2n && wi::neg_p (cst2v))
5586 sgnbit = wi::set_bit_in_zero (nprec - 1, nprec);
5587 if (sgnbit != 0)
5589 if (valv == sgnbit)
5591 cst2n = true;
5592 valn = true;
5593 goto gt_expr;
5595 if (tem == wi::mask (nprec - 1, false, nprec))
5597 cst2n = true;
5598 goto lt_expr;
5600 if (!cst2n)
5601 sgnbit = wi::zero (nprec);
5603 break;
5605 case GE_EXPR:
5606 /* Minimum unsigned value for >= if (VAL & CST2) == VAL
5607 is VAL and maximum unsigned value is ~0. For signed
5608 comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most significant bit
5609 set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has MSB set,
5610 the minimum is the same, and maximum is ~0U/2. */
5611 if (minv != valv)
5613 /* If (VAL & CST2) != VAL, X & CST2 can't be equal to
5614 VAL. */
5615 minv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5616 if (minv == valv)
5617 break;
5619 maxv = wi::mask (nprec - (cst2n ? 1 : 0), false, nprec);
5620 valid_p = true;
5621 break;
5623 case GT_EXPR:
5624 gt_expr:
5625 /* Find out smallest MINV where MINV > VAL
5626 && (MINV & CST2) == MINV, if any. If VAL is signed and
5627 CST2 has MSB set, compute it biased by 1 << (nprec - 1). */
5628 minv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5629 if (minv == valv)
5630 break;
5631 maxv = wi::mask (nprec - (cst2n ? 1 : 0), false, nprec);
5632 valid_p = true;
5633 break;
5635 case LE_EXPR:
5636 /* Minimum unsigned value for <= is 0 and maximum
5637 unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5638 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5639 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5640 as maximum.
5641 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5642 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5643 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5644 if (minv == valv)
5645 maxv = valv;
5646 else
5648 maxv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5649 if (maxv == valv)
5650 break;
5651 maxv -= 1;
5653 maxv |= ~cst2v;
5654 minv = sgnbit;
5655 valid_p = true;
5656 break;
5658 case LT_EXPR:
5659 lt_expr:
5660 /* Minimum unsigned value for < is 0 and maximum
5661 unsigned value is (VAL-1) | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5662 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5663 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5664 as maximum.
5665 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5666 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5667 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5668 if (minv == valv)
5670 if (valv == sgnbit)
5671 break;
5672 maxv = valv;
5674 else
5676 maxv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5677 if (maxv == valv)
5678 break;
5680 maxv -= 1;
5681 maxv |= ~cst2v;
5682 minv = sgnbit;
5683 valid_p = true;
5684 break;
5686 default:
5687 break;
5689 if (valid_p
5690 && (maxv - minv) != -1)
5692 tree tmp, new_val, type;
5693 int i;
5695 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
5696 if (names[i])
5698 wide_int maxv2 = maxv;
5699 tmp = names[i];
5700 type = TREE_TYPE (names[i]);
5701 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
5703 type = build_nonstandard_integer_type (nprec, 1);
5704 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, type, names[i]);
5706 if (minv != 0)
5708 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, tmp,
5709 wide_int_to_tree (type, -minv));
5710 maxv2 = maxv - minv;
5712 new_val = wide_int_to_tree (type, maxv2);
5714 if (dump_file)
5716 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5717 print_generic_expr (dump_file, names[i], 0);
5718 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5719 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5720 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5723 register_new_assert_for (names[i], tmp, LE_EXPR,
5724 new_val, NULL, e, bsi);
5731 /* OP is an operand of a truth value expression which is known to have
5732 a particular value. Register any asserts for OP and for any
5733 operands in OP's defining statement.
5735 If CODE is EQ_EXPR, then we want to register OP is zero (false),
5736 if CODE is NE_EXPR, then we want to register OP is nonzero (true). */
5738 static void
5739 register_edge_assert_for_1 (tree op, enum tree_code code,
5740 edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi)
5742 gimple *op_def;
5743 tree val;
5744 enum tree_code rhs_code;
5746 /* We only care about SSA_NAMEs. */
5747 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
5748 return;
5750 /* We know that OP will have a zero or nonzero value. If OP is used
5751 more than once go ahead and register an assert for OP. */
5752 if (live_on_edge (e, op))
5754 val = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op), 0);
5755 register_new_assert_for (op, op, code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
5758 /* Now look at how OP is set. If it's set from a comparison,
5759 a truth operation or some bit operations, then we may be able
5760 to register information about the operands of that assignment. */
5761 op_def = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (op);
5762 if (gimple_code (op_def) != GIMPLE_ASSIGN)
5763 return;
5765 rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def);
5767 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (rhs_code) == tcc_comparison)
5769 bool invert = (code == EQ_EXPR ? true : false);
5770 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5771 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def);
5773 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
5774 register_edge_assert_for_2 (op0, e, bsi, rhs_code, op0, op1, invert);
5775 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
5776 register_edge_assert_for_2 (op1, e, bsi, rhs_code, op0, op1, invert);
5778 else if ((code == NE_EXPR
5779 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
5780 || (code == EQ_EXPR
5781 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_IOR_EXPR))
5783 /* Recurse on each operand. */
5784 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5785 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def);
5786 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
5787 && has_single_use (op0))
5788 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, code, e, bsi);
5789 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME
5790 && has_single_use (op1))
5791 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, code, e, bsi);
5793 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_NOT_EXPR
5794 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (op_def))) == 1)
5796 /* Recurse, flipping CODE. */
5797 code = invert_tree_comparison (code, false);
5798 register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def), code, e, bsi);
5800 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == SSA_NAME)
5802 /* Recurse through the copy. */
5803 register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def), code, e, bsi);
5805 else if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def)))
5807 /* Recurse through the type conversion, unless it is a narrowing
5808 conversion or conversion from non-integral type. */
5809 tree rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5810 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs))
5811 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs))
5812 <= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op))))
5813 register_edge_assert_for_1 (rhs, code, e, bsi);
5817 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
5818 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by
5819 SI. */
5821 static void
5822 register_edge_assert_for (tree name, edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator si,
5823 enum tree_code cond_code, tree cond_op0,
5824 tree cond_op1)
5826 tree val;
5827 enum tree_code comp_code;
5828 bool is_else_edge = (e->flags & EDGE_FALSE_VALUE) != 0;
5830 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
5831 abnormal edges. */
5832 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (name))
5833 return;
5835 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name, cond_code,
5836 cond_op0, cond_op1,
5837 is_else_edge,
5838 &comp_code, &val))
5839 return;
5841 /* Register ASSERT_EXPRs for name. */
5842 register_edge_assert_for_2 (name, e, si, cond_code, cond_op0,
5843 cond_op1, is_else_edge);
5846 /* If COND is effectively an equality test of an SSA_NAME against
5847 the value zero or one, then we may be able to assert values
5848 for SSA_NAMEs which flow into COND. */
5850 /* In the case of NAME == 1 or NAME != 0, for BIT_AND_EXPR defining
5851 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_AND_EXPR
5852 have nonzero value. */
5853 if (((comp_code == EQ_EXPR && integer_onep (val))
5854 || (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (val))))
5856 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5858 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5859 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
5861 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5862 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5863 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, NE_EXPR, e, si);
5864 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, NE_EXPR, e, si);
5868 /* In the case of NAME == 0 or NAME != 1, for BIT_IOR_EXPR defining
5869 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_IOR_EXPR
5870 have zero value. */
5871 if (((comp_code == EQ_EXPR && integer_zerop (val))
5872 || (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_onep (val))))
5874 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5876 /* For BIT_IOR_EXPR only if NAME == 0 both operands have
5877 necessarily zero value, or if type-precision is one. */
5878 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5879 && (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
5880 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name)) == 1
5881 || comp_code == EQ_EXPR)))
5883 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5884 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5885 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, EQ_EXPR, e, si);
5886 register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, EQ_EXPR, e, si);
5892 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5893 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5894 The last statement of BB must be a COND_EXPR.
5896 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5897 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5898 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5900 static void
5901 find_conditional_asserts (basic_block bb, gcond *last)
5903 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi;
5904 tree op;
5905 edge_iterator ei;
5906 edge e;
5907 ssa_op_iter iter;
5909 bsi = gsi_for_stmt (last);
5911 /* Look for uses of the operands in each of the sub-graphs
5912 rooted at BB. We need to check each of the outgoing edges
5913 separately, so that we know what kind of ASSERT_EXPR to
5914 insert. */
5915 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
5917 if (e->dest == bb)
5918 continue;
5920 /* Register the necessary assertions for each operand in the
5921 conditional predicate. */
5922 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, last, iter, SSA_OP_USE)
5923 register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi,
5924 gimple_cond_code (last),
5925 gimple_cond_lhs (last),
5926 gimple_cond_rhs (last));
5930 struct case_info
5932 tree expr;
5933 basic_block bb;
5936 /* Compare two case labels sorting first by the destination bb index
5937 and then by the case value. */
5939 static int
5940 compare_case_labels (const void *p1, const void *p2)
5942 const struct case_info *ci1 = (const struct case_info *) p1;
5943 const struct case_info *ci2 = (const struct case_info *) p2;
5944 int idx1 = ci1->bb->index;
5945 int idx2 = ci2->bb->index;
5947 if (idx1 < idx2)
5948 return -1;
5949 else if (idx1 == idx2)
5951 /* Make sure the default label is first in a group. */
5952 if (!CASE_LOW (ci1->expr))
5953 return -1;
5954 else if (!CASE_LOW (ci2->expr))
5955 return 1;
5956 else
5957 return tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (ci1->expr),
5958 CASE_LOW (ci2->expr));
5960 else
5961 return 1;
5964 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5965 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5966 The last statement of BB must be a SWITCH_EXPR.
5968 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5969 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5970 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5972 static void
5973 find_switch_asserts (basic_block bb, gswitch *last)
5975 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi;
5976 tree op;
5977 edge e;
5978 struct case_info *ci;
5979 size_t n = gimple_switch_num_labels (last);
5980 #if GCC_VERSION >= 4000
5981 unsigned int idx;
5982 #else
5983 /* Work around GCC 3.4 bug (PR 37086). */
5984 volatile unsigned int idx;
5985 #endif
5987 bsi = gsi_for_stmt (last);
5988 op = gimple_switch_index (last);
5989 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
5990 return;
5992 /* Build a vector of case labels sorted by destination label. */
5993 ci = XNEWVEC (struct case_info, n);
5994 for (idx = 0; idx < n; ++idx)
5996 ci[idx].expr = gimple_switch_label (last, idx);
5997 ci[idx].bb = label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (ci[idx].expr));
5999 edge default_edge = find_edge (bb, ci[0].bb);
6000 qsort (ci, n, sizeof (struct case_info), compare_case_labels);
6002 for (idx = 0; idx < n; ++idx)
6004 tree min, max;
6005 tree cl = ci[idx].expr;
6006 basic_block cbb = ci[idx].bb;
6008 min = CASE_LOW (cl);
6009 max = CASE_HIGH (cl);
6011 /* If there are multiple case labels with the same destination
6012 we need to combine them to a single value range for the edge. */
6013 if (idx + 1 < n && cbb == ci[idx + 1].bb)
6015 /* Skip labels until the last of the group. */
6016 do {
6017 ++idx;
6018 } while (idx < n && cbb == ci[idx].bb);
6019 --idx;
6021 /* Pick up the maximum of the case label range. */
6022 if (CASE_HIGH (ci[idx].expr))
6023 max = CASE_HIGH (ci[idx].expr);
6024 else
6025 max = CASE_LOW (ci[idx].expr);
6028 /* Can't extract a useful assertion out of a range that includes the
6029 default label. */
6030 if (min == NULL_TREE)
6031 continue;
6033 /* Find the edge to register the assert expr on. */
6034 e = find_edge (bb, cbb);
6036 /* Register the necessary assertions for the operand in the
6037 SWITCH_EXPR. */
6038 register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi,
6039 max ? GE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
6040 op, fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op), min));
6041 if (max)
6042 register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi, LE_EXPR, op,
6043 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op), max));
6046 XDELETEVEC (ci);
6048 if (!live_on_edge (default_edge, op))
6049 return;
6051 /* Now register along the default label assertions that correspond to the
6052 anti-range of each label. */
6053 int insertion_limit = PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VRP_SWITCH_ASSERTIONS);
6054 if (insertion_limit == 0)
6055 return;
6057 /* We can't do this if the default case shares a label with another case. */
6058 tree default_cl = gimple_switch_default_label (last);
6059 for (idx = 1; idx < n; idx++)
6061 tree min, max;
6062 tree cl = gimple_switch_label (last, idx);
6063 if (CASE_LABEL (cl) == CASE_LABEL (default_cl))
6064 continue;
6066 min = CASE_LOW (cl);
6067 max = CASE_HIGH (cl);
6069 /* Combine contiguous case ranges to reduce the number of assertions
6070 to insert. */
6071 for (idx = idx + 1; idx < n; idx++)
6073 tree next_min, next_max;
6074 tree next_cl = gimple_switch_label (last, idx);
6075 if (CASE_LABEL (next_cl) == CASE_LABEL (default_cl))
6076 break;
6078 next_min = CASE_LOW (next_cl);
6079 next_max = CASE_HIGH (next_cl);
6081 wide_int difference = wi::sub (next_min, max ? max : min);
6082 if (wi::eq_p (difference, 1))
6083 max = next_max ? next_max : next_min;
6084 else
6085 break;
6087 idx--;
6089 if (max == NULL_TREE)
6091 /* Register the assertion OP != MIN. */
6092 min = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op), min);
6093 register_edge_assert_for (op, default_edge, bsi, NE_EXPR, op, min);
6095 else
6097 /* Register the assertion (unsigned)OP - MIN > (MAX - MIN),
6098 which will give OP the anti-range ~[MIN,MAX]. */
6099 tree uop = fold_convert (unsigned_type_for (TREE_TYPE (op)), op);
6100 min = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (uop), min);
6101 max = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (uop), max);
6103 tree lhs = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (uop), uop, min);
6104 tree rhs = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, max, min);
6105 register_new_assert_for (op, lhs, GT_EXPR, rhs,
6106 NULL, default_edge, bsi);
6109 if (--insertion_limit == 0)
6110 break;
6115 /* Traverse all the statements in block BB looking for statements that
6116 may generate useful assertions for the SSA names in their operand.
6117 If a statement produces a useful assertion A for name N_i, then the
6118 list of assertions already generated for N_i is scanned to
6119 determine if A is actually needed.
6121 If N_i already had the assertion A at a location dominating the
6122 current location, then nothing needs to be done. Otherwise, the
6123 new location for A is recorded instead.
6125 1- For every statement S in BB, all the variables used by S are
6126 added to bitmap FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
6128 2- If statement S uses an operand N in a way that exposes a known
6129 value range for N, then if N was not already generated by an
6130 ASSERT_EXPR, create a new assert location for N. For instance,
6131 if N is a pointer and the statement dereferences it, we can
6132 assume that N is not NULL.
6134 3- COND_EXPRs are a special case of #2. We can derive range
6135 information from the predicate but need to insert different
6136 ASSERT_EXPRs for each of the sub-graphs rooted at the
6137 conditional block. If the last statement of BB is a conditional
6138 expression of the form 'X op Y', then
6140 a) Remove X and Y from the set FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
6142 b) If the conditional is the only entry point to the sub-graph
6143 corresponding to the THEN_CLAUSE, recurse into it. On
6144 return, if X and/or Y are marked in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH, then
6145 an ASSERT_EXPR is added for the corresponding variable.
6147 c) Repeat step (b) on the ELSE_CLAUSE.
6149 d) Mark X and Y in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
6151 For instance,
6153 if (a == 9)
6154 b = a;
6155 else
6156 b = c + 1;
6158 In this case, an assertion on the THEN clause is useful to
6159 determine that 'a' is always 9 on that edge. However, an assertion
6160 on the ELSE clause would be unnecessary.
6162 4- If BB does not end in a conditional expression, then we recurse
6163 into BB's dominator children.
6165 At the end of the recursive traversal, every SSA name will have a
6166 list of locations where ASSERT_EXPRs should be added. When a new
6167 location for name N is found, it is registered by calling
6168 register_new_assert_for. That function keeps track of all the
6169 registered assertions to prevent adding unnecessary assertions.
6170 For instance, if a pointer P_4 is dereferenced more than once in a
6171 dominator tree, only the location dominating all the dereference of
6172 P_4 will receive an ASSERT_EXPR. */
6174 static void
6175 find_assert_locations_1 (basic_block bb, sbitmap live)
6177 gimple *last;
6179 last = last_stmt (bb);
6181 /* If BB's last statement is a conditional statement involving integer
6182 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
6183 if (last
6184 && gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_COND
6185 && !fp_predicate (last)
6186 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last, SSA_OP_USE))
6187 find_conditional_asserts (bb, as_a <gcond *> (last));
6189 /* If BB's last statement is a switch statement involving integer
6190 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
6191 if (last
6192 && gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
6193 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last, SSA_OP_USE))
6194 find_switch_asserts (bb, as_a <gswitch *> (last));
6196 /* Traverse all the statements in BB marking used names and looking
6197 for statements that may infer assertions for their used operands. */
6198 for (gimple_stmt_iterator si = gsi_last_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si);
6199 gsi_prev (&si))
6201 gimple *stmt;
6202 tree op;
6203 ssa_op_iter i;
6205 stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
6207 if (is_gimple_debug (stmt))
6208 continue;
6210 /* See if we can derive an assertion for any of STMT's operands. */
6211 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
6213 tree value;
6214 enum tree_code comp_code;
6216 /* If op is not live beyond this stmt, do not bother to insert
6217 asserts for it. */
6218 if (!bitmap_bit_p (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op)))
6219 continue;
6221 /* If OP is used in such a way that we can infer a value
6222 range for it, and we don't find a previous assertion for
6223 it, create a new assertion location node for OP. */
6224 if (infer_value_range (stmt, op, &comp_code, &value))
6226 /* If we are able to infer a nonzero value range for OP,
6227 then walk backwards through the use-def chain to see if OP
6228 was set via a typecast.
6230 If so, then we can also infer a nonzero value range
6231 for the operand of the NOP_EXPR. */
6232 if (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (value))
6234 tree t = op;
6235 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
6237 while (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
6238 && CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P
6239 (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt))
6240 && TREE_CODE
6241 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)) == SSA_NAME
6242 && POINTER_TYPE_P
6243 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt))))
6245 t = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
6246 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
6248 /* Note we want to register the assert for the
6249 operand of the NOP_EXPR after SI, not after the
6250 conversion. */
6251 if (bitmap_bit_p (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (t)))
6252 register_new_assert_for (t, t, comp_code, value,
6253 bb, NULL, si);
6257 register_new_assert_for (op, op, comp_code, value, bb, NULL, si);
6261 /* Update live. */
6262 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
6263 bitmap_set_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op));
6264 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_DEF)
6265 bitmap_clear_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op));
6268 /* Traverse all PHI nodes in BB, updating live. */
6269 for (gphi_iterator si = gsi_start_phis (bb); !gsi_end_p (si);
6270 gsi_next (&si))
6272 use_operand_p arg_p;
6273 ssa_op_iter i;
6274 gphi *phi = si.phi ();
6275 tree res = gimple_phi_result (phi);
6277 if (virtual_operand_p (res))
6278 continue;
6280 FOR_EACH_PHI_ARG (arg_p, phi, i, SSA_OP_USE)
6282 tree arg = USE_FROM_PTR (arg_p);
6283 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
6284 bitmap_set_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (arg));
6287 bitmap_clear_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (res));
6291 /* Do an RPO walk over the function computing SSA name liveness
6292 on-the-fly and deciding on assert expressions to insert. */
6294 static void
6295 find_assert_locations (void)
6297 int *rpo = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
6298 int *bb_rpo = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
6299 int *last_rpo = XCNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
6300 int rpo_cnt, i;
6302 live = XCNEWVEC (sbitmap, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
6303 rpo_cnt = pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL, rpo, false);
6304 for (i = 0; i < rpo_cnt; ++i)
6305 bb_rpo[rpo[i]] = i;
6307 /* Pre-seed loop latch liveness from loop header PHI nodes. Due to
6308 the order we compute liveness and insert asserts we otherwise
6309 fail to insert asserts into the loop latch. */
6310 loop_p loop;
6311 FOR_EACH_LOOP (loop, 0)
6313 i = loop->latch->index;
6314 unsigned int j = single_succ_edge (loop->latch)->dest_idx;
6315 for (gphi_iterator gsi = gsi_start_phis (loop->header);
6316 !gsi_end_p (gsi); gsi_next (&gsi))
6318 gphi *phi = gsi.phi ();
6319 if (virtual_operand_p (gimple_phi_result (phi)))
6320 continue;
6321 tree arg = gimple_phi_arg_def (phi, j);
6322 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
6324 if (live[i] == NULL)
6326 live[i] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names);
6327 bitmap_clear (live[i]);
6329 bitmap_set_bit (live[i], SSA_NAME_VERSION (arg));
6334 for (i = rpo_cnt - 1; i >= 0; --i)
6336 basic_block bb = BASIC_BLOCK_FOR_FN (cfun, rpo[i]);
6337 edge e;
6338 edge_iterator ei;
6340 if (!live[rpo[i]])
6342 live[rpo[i]] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names);
6343 bitmap_clear (live[rpo[i]]);
6346 /* Process BB and update the live information with uses in
6347 this block. */
6348 find_assert_locations_1 (bb, live[rpo[i]]);
6350 /* Merge liveness into the predecessor blocks and free it. */
6351 if (!bitmap_empty_p (live[rpo[i]]))
6353 int pred_rpo = i;
6354 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
6356 int pred = e->src->index;
6357 if ((e->flags & EDGE_DFS_BACK) || pred == ENTRY_BLOCK)
6358 continue;
6360 if (!live[pred])
6362 live[pred] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names);
6363 bitmap_clear (live[pred]);
6365 bitmap_ior (live[pred], live[pred], live[rpo[i]]);
6367 if (bb_rpo[pred] < pred_rpo)
6368 pred_rpo = bb_rpo[pred];
6371 /* Record the RPO number of the last visited block that needs
6372 live information from this block. */
6373 last_rpo[rpo[i]] = pred_rpo;
6375 else
6377 sbitmap_free (live[rpo[i]]);
6378 live[rpo[i]] = NULL;
6381 /* We can free all successors live bitmaps if all their
6382 predecessors have been visited already. */
6383 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
6384 if (last_rpo[e->dest->index] == i
6385 && live[e->dest->index])
6387 sbitmap_free (live[e->dest->index]);
6388 live[e->dest->index] = NULL;
6392 XDELETEVEC (rpo);
6393 XDELETEVEC (bb_rpo);
6394 XDELETEVEC (last_rpo);
6395 for (i = 0; i < last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun); ++i)
6396 if (live[i])
6397 sbitmap_free (live[i]);
6398 XDELETEVEC (live);
6401 /* Create an ASSERT_EXPR for NAME and insert it in the location
6402 indicated by LOC. Return true if we made any edge insertions. */
6404 static bool
6405 process_assert_insertions_for (tree name, assert_locus *loc)
6407 /* Build the comparison expression NAME_i COMP_CODE VAL. */
6408 gimple *stmt;
6409 tree cond;
6410 gimple *assert_stmt;
6411 edge_iterator ei;
6412 edge e;
6414 /* If we have X <=> X do not insert an assert expr for that. */
6415 if (loc->expr == loc->val)
6416 return false;
6418 cond = build2 (loc->comp_code, boolean_type_node, loc->expr, loc->val);
6419 assert_stmt = build_assert_expr_for (cond, name);
6420 if (loc->e)
6422 /* We have been asked to insert the assertion on an edge. This
6423 is used only by COND_EXPR and SWITCH_EXPR assertions. */
6424 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc->si)) == GIMPLE_COND
6425 || (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc->si))
6426 == GIMPLE_SWITCH));
6428 gsi_insert_on_edge (loc->e, assert_stmt);
6429 return true;
6432 /* If the stmt iterator points at the end then this is an insertion
6433 at the beginning of a block. */
6434 if (gsi_end_p (loc->si))
6436 gimple_stmt_iterator si = gsi_after_labels (loc->bb);
6437 gsi_insert_before (&si, assert_stmt, GSI_SAME_STMT);
6438 return false;
6441 /* Otherwise, we can insert right after LOC->SI iff the
6442 statement must not be the last statement in the block. */
6443 stmt = gsi_stmt (loc->si);
6444 if (!stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt))
6446 gsi_insert_after (&loc->si, assert_stmt, GSI_SAME_STMT);
6447 return false;
6450 /* If STMT must be the last statement in BB, we can only insert new
6451 assertions on the non-abnormal edge out of BB. Note that since
6452 STMT is not control flow, there may only be one non-abnormal/eh edge
6453 out of BB. */
6454 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, loc->bb->succs)
6455 if (!(e->flags & (EDGE_ABNORMAL|EDGE_EH)))
6457 gsi_insert_on_edge (e, assert_stmt);
6458 return true;
6461 gcc_unreachable ();
6464 /* Qsort helper for sorting assert locations. */
6466 static int
6467 compare_assert_loc (const void *pa, const void *pb)
6469 assert_locus * const a = *(assert_locus * const *)pa;
6470 assert_locus * const b = *(assert_locus * const *)pb;
6471 if (! a->e && b->e)
6472 return 1;
6473 else if (a->e && ! b->e)
6474 return -1;
6476 /* Sort after destination index. */
6477 if (! a->e && ! b->e)
6479 else if (a->e->dest->index > b->e->dest->index)
6480 return 1;
6481 else if (a->e->dest->index < b->e->dest->index)
6482 return -1;
6484 /* Sort after comp_code. */
6485 if (a->comp_code > b->comp_code)
6486 return 1;
6487 else if (a->comp_code < b->comp_code)
6488 return -1;
6490 /* Break the tie using hashing and source/bb index. */
6491 hashval_t ha = iterative_hash_expr (a->expr, iterative_hash_expr (a->val, 0));
6492 hashval_t hb = iterative_hash_expr (b->expr, iterative_hash_expr (b->val, 0));
6493 if (ha == hb)
6494 return (a->e && b->e
6495 ? a->e->src->index - b->e->src->index
6496 : a->bb->index - b->bb->index);
6497 return ha - hb;
6500 /* Process all the insertions registered for every name N_i registered
6501 in NEED_ASSERT_FOR. The list of assertions to be inserted are
6502 found in ASSERTS_FOR[i]. */
6504 static void
6505 process_assert_insertions (void)
6507 unsigned i;
6508 bitmap_iterator bi;
6509 bool update_edges_p = false;
6510 int num_asserts = 0;
6512 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6513 dump_all_asserts (dump_file);
6515 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for, 0, i, bi)
6517 assert_locus *loc = asserts_for[i];
6518 gcc_assert (loc);
6520 auto_vec<assert_locus *, 16> asserts;
6521 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6522 asserts.safe_push (loc);
6523 asserts.qsort (compare_assert_loc);
6525 /* Push down common asserts to successors and remove redundant ones. */
6526 unsigned ecnt = 0;
6527 assert_locus *common = NULL;
6528 unsigned commonj = 0;
6529 for (unsigned j = 0; j < asserts.length (); ++j)
6531 loc = asserts[j];
6532 if (! loc->e)
6533 common = NULL;
6534 else if (! common
6535 || loc->e->dest != common->e->dest
6536 || loc->comp_code != common->comp_code
6537 || ! operand_equal_p (loc->val, common->val, 0)
6538 || ! operand_equal_p (loc->expr, common->expr, 0))
6540 commonj = j;
6541 common = loc;
6542 ecnt = 1;
6544 else if (loc->e == asserts[j-1]->e)
6546 /* Remove duplicate asserts. */
6547 if (commonj == j - 1)
6549 commonj = j;
6550 common = loc;
6552 free (asserts[j-1]);
6553 asserts[j-1] = NULL;
6555 else
6557 ecnt++;
6558 if (EDGE_COUNT (common->e->dest->preds) == ecnt)
6560 /* We have the same assertion on all incoming edges of a BB.
6561 Insert it at the beginning of that block. */
6562 loc->bb = loc->e->dest;
6563 loc->e = NULL;
6564 loc->si = gsi_none ();
6565 common = NULL;
6566 /* Clear asserts commoned. */
6567 for (; commonj != j; ++commonj)
6568 if (asserts[commonj])
6570 free (asserts[commonj]);
6571 asserts[commonj] = NULL;
6577 for (unsigned j = 0; j < asserts.length (); ++j)
6579 loc = asserts[j];
6580 if (! loc)
6581 continue;
6582 update_edges_p |= process_assert_insertions_for (ssa_name (i), loc);
6583 num_asserts++;
6584 free (loc);
6588 if (update_edges_p)
6589 gsi_commit_edge_inserts ();
6591 statistics_counter_event (cfun, "Number of ASSERT_EXPR expressions inserted",
6592 num_asserts);
6596 /* Traverse the flowgraph looking for conditional jumps to insert range
6597 expressions. These range expressions are meant to provide information
6598 to optimizations that need to reason in terms of value ranges. They
6599 will not be expanded into RTL. For instance, given:
6601 x = ...
6602 y = ...
6603 if (x < y)
6604 y = x - 2;
6605 else
6606 x = y + 3;
6608 this pass will transform the code into:
6610 x = ...
6611 y = ...
6612 if (x < y)
6614 x = ASSERT_EXPR <x, x < y>
6615 y = x - 2
6617 else
6619 y = ASSERT_EXPR <y, x >= y>
6620 x = y + 3
6623 The idea is that once copy and constant propagation have run, other
6624 optimizations will be able to determine what ranges of values can 'x'
6625 take in different paths of the code, simply by checking the reaching
6626 definition of 'x'. */
6628 static void
6629 insert_range_assertions (void)
6631 need_assert_for = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
6632 asserts_for = XCNEWVEC (assert_locus *, num_ssa_names);
6634 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
6636 find_assert_locations ();
6637 if (!bitmap_empty_p (need_assert_for))
6639 process_assert_insertions ();
6640 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa_no_phi);
6643 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6645 fprintf (dump_file, "\nSSA form after inserting ASSERT_EXPRs\n");
6646 dump_function_to_file (current_function_decl, dump_file, dump_flags);
6649 free (asserts_for);
6650 BITMAP_FREE (need_assert_for);
6653 /* Checks one ARRAY_REF in REF, located at LOCUS. Ignores flexible arrays
6654 and "struct" hacks. If VRP can determine that the
6655 array subscript is a constant, check if it is outside valid
6656 range. If the array subscript is a RANGE, warn if it is
6657 non-overlapping with valid range.
6658 IGNORE_OFF_BY_ONE is true if the ARRAY_REF is inside a ADDR_EXPR. */
6660 static void
6661 check_array_ref (location_t location, tree ref, bool ignore_off_by_one)
6663 value_range *vr = NULL;
6664 tree low_sub, up_sub;
6665 tree low_bound, up_bound, up_bound_p1;
6667 if (TREE_NO_WARNING (ref))
6668 return;
6670 low_sub = up_sub = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 1);
6671 up_bound = array_ref_up_bound (ref);
6673 /* Can not check flexible arrays. */
6674 if (!up_bound
6675 || TREE_CODE (up_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
6676 return;
6678 /* Accesses to trailing arrays via pointers may access storage
6679 beyond the types array bounds. */
6680 if (warn_array_bounds < 2
6681 && array_at_struct_end_p (ref))
6682 return;
6684 low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (ref);
6685 up_bound_p1 = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, up_bound,
6686 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (up_bound), 1));
6688 /* Empty array. */
6689 if (tree_int_cst_equal (low_bound, up_bound_p1))
6691 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6692 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6693 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6696 if (TREE_CODE (low_sub) == SSA_NAME)
6698 vr = get_value_range (low_sub);
6699 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
6701 low_sub = vr->type == VR_RANGE ? vr->max : vr->min;
6702 up_sub = vr->type == VR_RANGE ? vr->min : vr->max;
6706 if (vr && vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
6708 if (TREE_CODE (up_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6709 && (ignore_off_by_one
6710 ? tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound, up_sub)
6711 : tree_int_cst_le (up_bound, up_sub))
6712 && TREE_CODE (low_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6713 && tree_int_cst_le (low_sub, low_bound))
6715 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6716 "array subscript is outside array bounds");
6717 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6720 else if (TREE_CODE (up_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6721 && (ignore_off_by_one
6722 ? !tree_int_cst_le (up_sub, up_bound_p1)
6723 : !tree_int_cst_le (up_sub, up_bound)))
6725 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6727 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6728 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, ref);
6729 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6731 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6732 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6733 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6735 else if (TREE_CODE (low_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6736 && tree_int_cst_lt (low_sub, low_bound))
6738 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6740 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6741 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, ref);
6742 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6744 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6745 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6746 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6750 /* Searches if the expr T, located at LOCATION computes
6751 address of an ARRAY_REF, and call check_array_ref on it. */
6753 static void
6754 search_for_addr_array (tree t, location_t location)
6756 /* Check each ARRAY_REFs in the reference chain. */
6759 if (TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_REF)
6760 check_array_ref (location, t, true /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6762 t = TREE_OPERAND (t, 0);
6764 while (handled_component_p (t));
6766 if (TREE_CODE (t) == MEM_REF
6767 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6768 && !TREE_NO_WARNING (t))
6770 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0), 0);
6771 tree low_bound, up_bound, el_sz;
6772 offset_int idx;
6773 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) != ARRAY_TYPE
6774 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem))) == ARRAY_TYPE
6775 || !TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
6776 return;
6778 low_bound = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6779 up_bound = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6780 el_sz = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6781 if (!low_bound
6782 || TREE_CODE (low_bound) != INTEGER_CST
6783 || !up_bound
6784 || TREE_CODE (up_bound) != INTEGER_CST
6785 || !el_sz
6786 || TREE_CODE (el_sz) != INTEGER_CST)
6787 return;
6789 idx = mem_ref_offset (t);
6790 idx = wi::sdiv_trunc (idx, wi::to_offset (el_sz));
6791 if (idx < 0)
6793 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6795 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6796 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, t);
6797 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6799 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6800 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6801 TREE_NO_WARNING (t) = 1;
6803 else if (idx > (wi::to_offset (up_bound)
6804 - wi::to_offset (low_bound) + 1))
6806 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6808 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6809 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, t);
6810 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6812 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6813 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6814 TREE_NO_WARNING (t) = 1;
6819 /* walk_tree() callback that checks if *TP is
6820 an ARRAY_REF inside an ADDR_EXPR (in which an array
6821 subscript one outside the valid range is allowed). Call
6822 check_array_ref for each ARRAY_REF found. The location is
6823 passed in DATA. */
6825 static tree
6826 check_array_bounds (tree *tp, int *walk_subtree, void *data)
6828 tree t = *tp;
6829 struct walk_stmt_info *wi = (struct walk_stmt_info *) data;
6830 location_t location;
6832 if (EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (t))
6833 location = EXPR_LOCATION (t);
6834 else
6836 location_t *locp = (location_t *) wi->info;
6837 location = *locp;
6840 *walk_subtree = TRUE;
6842 if (TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_REF)
6843 check_array_ref (location, t, false /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6845 else if (TREE_CODE (t) == ADDR_EXPR)
6847 search_for_addr_array (t, location);
6848 *walk_subtree = FALSE;
6851 return NULL_TREE;
6854 /* Walk over all statements of all reachable BBs and call check_array_bounds
6855 on them. */
6857 static void
6858 check_all_array_refs (void)
6860 basic_block bb;
6861 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
6863 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
6865 edge_iterator ei;
6866 edge e;
6867 bool executable = false;
6869 /* Skip blocks that were found to be unreachable. */
6870 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
6871 executable |= !!(e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE);
6872 if (!executable)
6873 continue;
6875 for (si = gsi_start_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si); gsi_next (&si))
6877 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
6878 struct walk_stmt_info wi;
6879 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt)
6880 || is_gimple_debug (stmt))
6881 continue;
6883 memset (&wi, 0, sizeof (wi));
6885 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
6886 wi.info = &loc;
6888 walk_gimple_op (gsi_stmt (si),
6889 check_array_bounds,
6890 &wi);
6895 /* Return true if all imm uses of VAR are either in STMT, or
6896 feed (optionally through a chain of single imm uses) GIMPLE_COND
6897 in basic block COND_BB. */
6899 static bool
6900 all_imm_uses_in_stmt_or_feed_cond (tree var, gimple *stmt, basic_block cond_bb)
6902 use_operand_p use_p, use2_p;
6903 imm_use_iterator iter;
6905 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_FAST (use_p, iter, var)
6906 if (USE_STMT (use_p) != stmt)
6908 gimple *use_stmt = USE_STMT (use_p), *use_stmt2;
6909 if (is_gimple_debug (use_stmt))
6910 continue;
6911 while (is_gimple_assign (use_stmt)
6912 && TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt)) == SSA_NAME
6913 && single_imm_use (gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt),
6914 &use2_p, &use_stmt2))
6915 use_stmt = use_stmt2;
6916 if (gimple_code (use_stmt) != GIMPLE_COND
6917 || gimple_bb (use_stmt) != cond_bb)
6918 return false;
6920 return true;
6923 /* Handle
6924 _4 = x_3 & 31;
6925 if (_4 != 0)
6926 goto <bb 6>;
6927 else
6928 goto <bb 7>;
6929 <bb 6>:
6930 __builtin_unreachable ();
6931 <bb 7>:
6932 x_5 = ASSERT_EXPR <x_3, ...>;
6933 If x_3 has no other immediate uses (checked by caller),
6934 var is the x_3 var from ASSERT_EXPR, we can clear low 5 bits
6935 from the non-zero bitmask. */
6937 static void
6938 maybe_set_nonzero_bits (basic_block bb, tree var)
6940 edge e = single_pred_edge (bb);
6941 basic_block cond_bb = e->src;
6942 gimple *stmt = last_stmt (cond_bb);
6943 tree cst;
6945 if (stmt == NULL
6946 || gimple_code (stmt) != GIMPLE_COND
6947 || gimple_cond_code (stmt) != ((e->flags & EDGE_TRUE_VALUE)
6948 ? EQ_EXPR : NE_EXPR)
6949 || TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt)) != SSA_NAME
6950 || !integer_zerop (gimple_cond_rhs (stmt)))
6951 return;
6953 stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt));
6954 if (!is_gimple_assign (stmt)
6955 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) != BIT_AND_EXPR
6956 || TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt)) != INTEGER_CST)
6957 return;
6958 if (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt) != var)
6960 gimple *stmt2;
6962 if (TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)) != SSA_NAME)
6963 return;
6964 stmt2 = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
6965 if (!gimple_assign_cast_p (stmt2)
6966 || gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt2) != var
6967 || !CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt2))
6968 || (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
6969 != TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (var))))
6970 return;
6972 cst = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
6973 set_nonzero_bits (var, wi::bit_and_not (get_nonzero_bits (var), cst));
6976 /* Convert range assertion expressions into the implied copies and
6977 copy propagate away the copies. Doing the trivial copy propagation
6978 here avoids the need to run the full copy propagation pass after
6979 VRP.
6981 FIXME, this will eventually lead to copy propagation removing the
6982 names that had useful range information attached to them. For
6983 instance, if we had the assertion N_i = ASSERT_EXPR <N_j, N_j > 3>,
6984 then N_i will have the range [3, +INF].
6986 However, by converting the assertion into the implied copy
6987 operation N_i = N_j, we will then copy-propagate N_j into the uses
6988 of N_i and lose the range information. We may want to hold on to
6989 ASSERT_EXPRs a little while longer as the ranges could be used in
6990 things like jump threading.
6992 The problem with keeping ASSERT_EXPRs around is that passes after
6993 VRP need to handle them appropriately.
6995 Another approach would be to make the range information a first
6996 class property of the SSA_NAME so that it can be queried from
6997 any pass. This is made somewhat more complex by the need for
6998 multiple ranges to be associated with one SSA_NAME. */
7000 static void
7001 remove_range_assertions (void)
7003 basic_block bb;
7004 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
7005 /* 1 if looking at ASSERT_EXPRs immediately at the beginning of
7006 a basic block preceeded by GIMPLE_COND branching to it and
7007 __builtin_trap, -1 if not yet checked, 0 otherwise. */
7008 int is_unreachable;
7010 /* Note that the BSI iterator bump happens at the bottom of the
7011 loop and no bump is necessary if we're removing the statement
7012 referenced by the current BSI. */
7013 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
7014 for (si = gsi_after_labels (bb), is_unreachable = -1; !gsi_end_p (si);)
7016 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
7018 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
7019 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == ASSERT_EXPR)
7021 tree lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (stmt);
7022 tree rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
7023 tree var;
7025 var = ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (rhs);
7027 if (TREE_CODE (var) == SSA_NAME
7028 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
7029 && SSA_NAME_RANGE_INFO (lhs))
7031 if (is_unreachable == -1)
7033 is_unreachable = 0;
7034 if (single_pred_p (bb)
7035 && assert_unreachable_fallthru_edge_p
7036 (single_pred_edge (bb)))
7037 is_unreachable = 1;
7039 /* Handle
7040 if (x_7 >= 10 && x_7 < 20)
7041 __builtin_unreachable ();
7042 x_8 = ASSERT_EXPR <x_7, ...>;
7043 if the only uses of x_7 are in the ASSERT_EXPR and
7044 in the condition. In that case, we can copy the
7045 range info from x_8 computed in this pass also
7046 for x_7. */
7047 if (is_unreachable
7048 && all_imm_uses_in_stmt_or_feed_cond (var, stmt,
7049 single_pred (bb)))
7051 set_range_info (var, SSA_NAME_RANGE_TYPE (lhs),
7052 SSA_NAME_RANGE_INFO (lhs)->get_min (),
7053 SSA_NAME_RANGE_INFO (lhs)->get_max ());
7054 maybe_set_nonzero_bits (bb, var);
7058 /* Propagate the RHS into every use of the LHS. For SSA names
7059 also propagate abnormals as it merely restores the original
7060 IL in this case (an replace_uses_by would assert). */
7061 if (TREE_CODE (var) == SSA_NAME)
7063 imm_use_iterator iter;
7064 use_operand_p use_p;
7065 gimple *use_stmt;
7066 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt, iter, lhs)
7067 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_ON_STMT (use_p, iter)
7068 SET_USE (use_p, var);
7070 else
7071 replace_uses_by (lhs, var);
7073 /* And finally, remove the copy, it is not needed. */
7074 gsi_remove (&si, true);
7075 release_defs (stmt);
7077 else
7079 if (!is_gimple_debug (gsi_stmt (si)))
7080 is_unreachable = 0;
7081 gsi_next (&si);
7087 /* Return true if STMT is interesting for VRP. */
7089 static bool
7090 stmt_interesting_for_vrp (gimple *stmt)
7092 if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_PHI)
7094 tree res = gimple_phi_result (stmt);
7095 return (!virtual_operand_p (res)
7096 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res))
7097 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res))));
7099 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt) || is_gimple_call (stmt))
7101 tree lhs = gimple_get_lhs (stmt);
7103 /* In general, assignments with virtual operands are not useful
7104 for deriving ranges, with the obvious exception of calls to
7105 builtin functions. */
7106 if (lhs && TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME
7107 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
7108 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
7109 && (is_gimple_call (stmt)
7110 || !gimple_vuse (stmt)))
7111 return true;
7112 else if (is_gimple_call (stmt) && gimple_call_internal_p (stmt))
7113 switch (gimple_call_internal_fn (stmt))
7115 case IFN_ADD_OVERFLOW:
7116 case IFN_SUB_OVERFLOW:
7117 case IFN_MUL_OVERFLOW:
7118 /* These internal calls return _Complex integer type,
7119 but are interesting to VRP nevertheless. */
7120 if (lhs && TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME)
7121 return true;
7122 break;
7123 default:
7124 break;
7127 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND
7128 || gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
7129 return true;
7131 return false;
7134 /* Initialize VRP lattice. */
7136 static void
7137 vrp_initialize_lattice ()
7139 values_propagated = false;
7140 num_vr_values = num_ssa_names;
7141 vr_value = XCNEWVEC (value_range *, num_vr_values);
7142 vr_phi_edge_counts = XCNEWVEC (int, num_ssa_names);
7143 bitmap_obstack_initialize (&vrp_equiv_obstack);
7146 /* Initialization required by ssa_propagate engine. */
7148 static void
7149 vrp_initialize ()
7151 basic_block bb;
7153 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
7155 for (gphi_iterator si = gsi_start_phis (bb); !gsi_end_p (si);
7156 gsi_next (&si))
7158 gphi *phi = si.phi ();
7159 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (phi))
7161 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
7162 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (lhs));
7163 prop_set_simulate_again (phi, false);
7165 else
7166 prop_set_simulate_again (phi, true);
7169 for (gimple_stmt_iterator si = gsi_start_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si);
7170 gsi_next (&si))
7172 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
7174 /* If the statement is a control insn, then we do not
7175 want to avoid simulating the statement once. Failure
7176 to do so means that those edges will never get added. */
7177 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt))
7178 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, true);
7179 else if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt))
7181 set_defs_to_varying (stmt);
7182 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, false);
7184 else
7185 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, true);
7190 /* Return the singleton value-range for NAME or NAME. */
7192 static inline tree
7193 vrp_valueize (tree name)
7195 if (TREE_CODE (name) == SSA_NAME)
7197 value_range *vr = get_value_range (name);
7198 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
7199 && (TREE_CODE (vr->min) == SSA_NAME
7200 || is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min))
7201 && vrp_operand_equal_p (vr->min, vr->max))
7202 return vr->min;
7204 return name;
7207 /* Return the singleton value-range for NAME if that is a constant
7208 but signal to not follow SSA edges. */
7210 static inline tree
7211 vrp_valueize_1 (tree name)
7213 if (TREE_CODE (name) == SSA_NAME)
7215 /* If the definition may be simulated again we cannot follow
7216 this SSA edge as the SSA propagator does not necessarily
7217 re-visit the use. */
7218 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
7219 if (!gimple_nop_p (def_stmt)
7220 && prop_simulate_again_p (def_stmt))
7221 return NULL_TREE;
7222 value_range *vr = get_value_range (name);
7223 if (range_int_cst_singleton_p (vr))
7224 return vr->min;
7226 return name;
7229 /* Visit assignment STMT. If it produces an interesting range, record
7230 the range in VR and set LHS to OUTPUT_P. */
7232 static void
7233 vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (gimple *stmt, tree *output_p, value_range *vr)
7235 tree lhs;
7236 enum gimple_code code = gimple_code (stmt);
7237 lhs = gimple_get_lhs (stmt);
7238 *output_p = NULL_TREE;
7240 /* We only keep track of ranges in integral and pointer types. */
7241 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME
7242 && ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
7243 /* It is valid to have NULL MIN/MAX values on a type. See
7244 build_range_type. */
7245 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
7246 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
7247 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))))
7249 *output_p = lhs;
7251 /* Try folding the statement to a constant first. */
7252 tree tem = gimple_fold_stmt_to_constant_1 (stmt, vrp_valueize,
7253 vrp_valueize_1);
7254 if (tem)
7256 if (TREE_CODE (tem) == SSA_NAME
7257 && (SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (tem)
7258 || ! prop_simulate_again_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (tem))))
7260 extract_range_from_ssa_name (vr, tem);
7261 return;
7263 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (tem))
7265 set_value_range_to_value (vr, tem, NULL);
7266 return;
7269 /* Then dispatch to value-range extracting functions. */
7270 if (code == GIMPLE_CALL)
7271 extract_range_basic (vr, stmt);
7272 else
7273 extract_range_from_assignment (vr, as_a <gassign *> (stmt));
7277 /* Helper that gets the value range of the SSA_NAME with version I
7278 or a symbolic range containing the SSA_NAME only if the value range
7279 is varying or undefined. */
7281 static inline value_range
7282 get_vr_for_comparison (int i)
7284 value_range vr = *get_value_range (ssa_name (i));
7286 /* If name N_i does not have a valid range, use N_i as its own
7287 range. This allows us to compare against names that may
7288 have N_i in their ranges. */
7289 if (vr.type == VR_VARYING || vr.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7291 vr.type = VR_RANGE;
7292 vr.min = ssa_name (i);
7293 vr.max = ssa_name (i);
7296 return vr;
7299 /* Compare all the value ranges for names equivalent to VAR with VAL
7300 using comparison code COMP. Return the same value returned by
7301 compare_range_with_value, including the setting of
7302 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P. */
7304 static tree
7305 compare_name_with_value (enum tree_code comp, tree var, tree val,
7306 bool *strict_overflow_p, bool use_equiv_p)
7308 bitmap_iterator bi;
7309 unsigned i;
7310 bitmap e;
7311 tree retval, t;
7312 int used_strict_overflow;
7313 bool sop;
7314 value_range equiv_vr;
7316 /* Get the set of equivalences for VAR. */
7317 e = get_value_range (var)->equiv;
7319 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
7320 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
7321 used_strict_overflow = -1;
7323 /* Compare vars' value range with val. */
7324 equiv_vr = get_vr_for_comparison (SSA_NAME_VERSION (var));
7325 sop = false;
7326 retval = compare_range_with_value (comp, &equiv_vr, val, &sop);
7327 if (retval)
7328 used_strict_overflow = sop ? 1 : 0;
7330 /* If the equiv set is empty we have done all work we need to do. */
7331 if (e == NULL)
7333 if (retval
7334 && used_strict_overflow > 0)
7335 *strict_overflow_p = true;
7336 return retval;
7339 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e, 0, i, bi)
7341 tree name = ssa_name (i);
7342 if (! name)
7343 continue;
7345 if (! use_equiv_p
7346 && ! SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (name)
7347 && prop_simulate_again_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name)))
7348 continue;
7350 equiv_vr = get_vr_for_comparison (i);
7351 sop = false;
7352 t = compare_range_with_value (comp, &equiv_vr, val, &sop);
7353 if (t)
7355 /* If we get different answers from different members
7356 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
7357 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
7358 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
7359 if (retval != NULL
7360 && t != retval)
7362 retval = NULL_TREE;
7363 break;
7365 retval = t;
7367 if (!sop)
7368 used_strict_overflow = 0;
7369 else if (used_strict_overflow < 0)
7370 used_strict_overflow = 1;
7374 if (retval
7375 && used_strict_overflow > 0)
7376 *strict_overflow_p = true;
7378 return retval;
7382 /* Given a comparison code COMP and names N1 and N2, compare all the
7383 ranges equivalent to N1 against all the ranges equivalent to N2
7384 to determine the value of N1 COMP N2. Return the same value
7385 returned by compare_ranges. Set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate
7386 whether we relied on an overflow infinity in the comparison. */
7389 static tree
7390 compare_names (enum tree_code comp, tree n1, tree n2,
7391 bool *strict_overflow_p)
7393 tree t, retval;
7394 bitmap e1, e2;
7395 bitmap_iterator bi1, bi2;
7396 unsigned i1, i2;
7397 int used_strict_overflow;
7398 static bitmap_obstack *s_obstack = NULL;
7399 static bitmap s_e1 = NULL, s_e2 = NULL;
7401 /* Compare the ranges of every name equivalent to N1 against the
7402 ranges of every name equivalent to N2. */
7403 e1 = get_value_range (n1)->equiv;
7404 e2 = get_value_range (n2)->equiv;
7406 /* Use the fake bitmaps if e1 or e2 are not available. */
7407 if (s_obstack == NULL)
7409 s_obstack = XNEW (bitmap_obstack);
7410 bitmap_obstack_initialize (s_obstack);
7411 s_e1 = BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack);
7412 s_e2 = BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack);
7414 if (e1 == NULL)
7415 e1 = s_e1;
7416 if (e2 == NULL)
7417 e2 = s_e2;
7419 /* Add N1 and N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid
7420 duplicating the body of the loop just to check N1 and N2
7421 ranges. */
7422 bitmap_set_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
7423 bitmap_set_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
7425 /* If the equivalence sets have a common intersection, then the two
7426 names can be compared without checking their ranges. */
7427 if (bitmap_intersect_p (e1, e2))
7429 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
7430 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
7432 return (comp == EQ_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
7433 ? boolean_true_node
7434 : boolean_false_node;
7437 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
7438 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
7439 used_strict_overflow = -1;
7441 /* Otherwise, compare all the equivalent ranges. First, add N1 and
7442 N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid duplicating the body
7443 of the loop just to check N1 and N2 ranges. */
7444 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e1, 0, i1, bi1)
7446 if (! ssa_name (i1))
7447 continue;
7449 value_range vr1 = get_vr_for_comparison (i1);
7451 t = retval = NULL_TREE;
7452 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e2, 0, i2, bi2)
7454 if (! ssa_name (i2))
7455 continue;
7457 bool sop = false;
7459 value_range vr2 = get_vr_for_comparison (i2);
7461 t = compare_ranges (comp, &vr1, &vr2, &sop);
7462 if (t)
7464 /* If we get different answers from different members
7465 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
7466 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
7467 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
7468 if (retval != NULL
7469 && t != retval)
7471 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
7472 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
7473 return NULL_TREE;
7475 retval = t;
7477 if (!sop)
7478 used_strict_overflow = 0;
7479 else if (used_strict_overflow < 0)
7480 used_strict_overflow = 1;
7484 if (retval)
7486 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
7487 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
7488 if (used_strict_overflow > 0)
7489 *strict_overflow_p = true;
7490 return retval;
7494 /* None of the equivalent ranges are useful in computing this
7495 comparison. */
7496 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
7497 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
7498 return NULL_TREE;
7501 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv & other
7502 optimizers. */
7504 static tree
7505 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges (enum tree_code code,
7506 tree op0, tree op1,
7507 bool * strict_overflow_p)
7509 value_range *vr0, *vr1;
7511 vr0 = (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (op0) : NULL;
7512 vr1 = (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (op1) : NULL;
7514 tree res = NULL_TREE;
7515 if (vr0 && vr1)
7516 res = compare_ranges (code, vr0, vr1, strict_overflow_p);
7517 if (!res && vr0)
7518 res = compare_range_with_value (code, vr0, op1, strict_overflow_p);
7519 if (!res && vr1)
7520 res = (compare_range_with_value
7521 (swap_tree_comparison (code), vr1, op0, strict_overflow_p));
7522 return res;
7525 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv. */
7527 static tree
7528 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code code, tree op0,
7529 tree op1, bool use_equiv_p,
7530 bool *strict_overflow_p, bool *only_ranges)
7532 tree ret;
7533 if (only_ranges)
7534 *only_ranges = true;
7536 /* We only deal with integral and pointer types. */
7537 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0))
7538 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0)))
7539 return NULL_TREE;
7541 if ((ret = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges
7542 (code, op0, op1, strict_overflow_p)))
7543 return ret;
7544 if (only_ranges)
7545 *only_ranges = false;
7546 /* Do not use compare_names during propagation, it's quadratic. */
7547 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME && TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME
7548 && use_equiv_p)
7549 return compare_names (code, op0, op1, strict_overflow_p);
7550 else if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
7551 return compare_name_with_value (code, op0, op1,
7552 strict_overflow_p, use_equiv_p);
7553 else if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
7554 return compare_name_with_value (swap_tree_comparison (code), op1, op0,
7555 strict_overflow_p, use_equiv_p);
7556 return NULL_TREE;
7559 /* Given (CODE OP0 OP1) within STMT, try to simplify it based on value range
7560 information. Return NULL if the conditional can not be evaluated.
7561 The ranges of all the names equivalent with the operands in COND
7562 will be used when trying to compute the value. If the result is
7563 based on undefined signed overflow, issue a warning if
7564 appropriate. */
7566 static tree
7567 vrp_evaluate_conditional (tree_code code, tree op0, tree op1, gimple *stmt)
7569 bool sop;
7570 tree ret;
7571 bool only_ranges;
7573 /* Some passes and foldings leak constants with overflow flag set
7574 into the IL. Avoid doing wrong things with these and bail out. */
7575 if ((TREE_CODE (op0) == INTEGER_CST
7576 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op0))
7577 || (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST
7578 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op1)))
7579 return NULL_TREE;
7581 sop = false;
7582 ret = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code, op0, op1, true, &sop,
7583 &only_ranges);
7585 if (ret && sop)
7587 enum warn_strict_overflow_code wc;
7588 const char* warnmsg;
7590 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (ret))
7592 wc = WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_CONDITIONAL;
7593 warnmsg = G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
7594 "simplifying conditional to constant");
7596 else
7598 wc = WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_COMPARISON;
7599 warnmsg = G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
7600 "simplifying conditional");
7603 if (issue_strict_overflow_warning (wc))
7605 location_t location;
7607 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
7608 location = input_location;
7609 else
7610 location = gimple_location (stmt);
7611 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow, "%s", warnmsg);
7615 if (warn_type_limits
7616 && ret && only_ranges
7617 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
7618 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
7620 /* If the comparison is being folded and the operand on the LHS
7621 is being compared against a constant value that is outside of
7622 the natural range of OP0's type, then the predicate will
7623 always fold regardless of the value of OP0. If -Wtype-limits
7624 was specified, emit a warning. */
7625 tree type = TREE_TYPE (op0);
7626 value_range *vr0 = get_value_range (op0);
7628 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE
7629 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
7630 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0->min)
7631 && vrp_val_is_max (vr0->max)
7632 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
7634 location_t location;
7636 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
7637 location = input_location;
7638 else
7639 location = gimple_location (stmt);
7641 warning_at (location, OPT_Wtype_limits,
7642 integer_zerop (ret)
7643 ? G_("comparison always false "
7644 "due to limited range of data type")
7645 : G_("comparison always true "
7646 "due to limited range of data type"));
7650 return ret;
7654 /* Visit conditional statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
7655 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
7656 *TAKEN_EDGE_P. Otherwise, set *TAKEN_EDGE_P to NULL. */
7658 static void
7659 vrp_visit_cond_stmt (gcond *stmt, edge *taken_edge_p)
7661 tree val;
7662 bool sop;
7664 *taken_edge_p = NULL;
7666 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7668 tree use;
7669 ssa_op_iter i;
7671 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting conditional with predicate: ");
7672 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
7673 fprintf (dump_file, "\nWith known ranges\n");
7675 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (use, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
7677 fprintf (dump_file, "\t");
7678 print_generic_expr (dump_file, use, 0);
7679 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
7680 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr_value[SSA_NAME_VERSION (use)]);
7683 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7686 /* Compute the value of the predicate COND by checking the known
7687 ranges of each of its operands.
7689 Note that we cannot evaluate all the equivalent ranges here
7690 because those ranges may not yet be final and with the current
7691 propagation strategy, we cannot determine when the value ranges
7692 of the names in the equivalence set have changed.
7694 For instance, given the following code fragment
7696 i_5 = PHI <8, i_13>
7698 i_14 = ASSERT_EXPR <i_5, i_5 != 0>
7699 if (i_14 == 1)
7702 Assume that on the first visit to i_14, i_5 has the temporary
7703 range [8, 8] because the second argument to the PHI function is
7704 not yet executable. We derive the range ~[0, 0] for i_14 and the
7705 equivalence set { i_5 }. So, when we visit 'if (i_14 == 1)' for
7706 the first time, since i_14 is equivalent to the range [8, 8], we
7707 determine that the predicate is always false.
7709 On the next round of propagation, i_13 is determined to be
7710 VARYING, which causes i_5 to drop down to VARYING. So, another
7711 visit to i_14 is scheduled. In this second visit, we compute the
7712 exact same range and equivalence set for i_14, namely ~[0, 0] and
7713 { i_5 }. But we did not have the previous range for i_5
7714 registered, so vrp_visit_assignment thinks that the range for
7715 i_14 has not changed. Therefore, the predicate 'if (i_14 == 1)'
7716 is not visited again, which stops propagation from visiting
7717 statements in the THEN clause of that if().
7719 To properly fix this we would need to keep the previous range
7720 value for the names in the equivalence set. This way we would've
7721 discovered that from one visit to the other i_5 changed from
7722 range [8, 8] to VR_VARYING.
7724 However, fixing this apparent limitation may not be worth the
7725 additional checking. Testing on several code bases (GCC, DLV,
7726 MICO, TRAMP3D and SPEC2000) showed that doing this results in
7727 4 more predicates folded in SPEC. */
7728 sop = false;
7730 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (gimple_cond_code (stmt),
7731 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt),
7732 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt),
7733 false, &sop, NULL);
7734 if (val)
7736 if (!sop)
7737 *taken_edge_p = find_taken_edge (gimple_bb (stmt), val);
7738 else
7740 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7741 fprintf (dump_file,
7742 "\nIgnoring predicate evaluation because "
7743 "it assumes that signed overflow is undefined");
7744 val = NULL_TREE;
7748 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7750 fprintf (dump_file, "\nPredicate evaluates to: ");
7751 if (val == NULL_TREE)
7752 fprintf (dump_file, "DON'T KNOW\n");
7753 else
7754 print_generic_stmt (dump_file, val, 0);
7758 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the index *IDX of the CASE_LABEL
7759 that includes the value VAL. The search is restricted to the range
7760 [START_IDX, n - 1] where n is the size of VEC.
7762 If there is a CASE_LABEL for VAL, its index is placed in IDX and true is
7763 returned.
7765 If there is no CASE_LABEL for VAL and there is one that is larger than VAL,
7766 it is placed in IDX and false is returned.
7768 If VAL is larger than any CASE_LABEL, n is placed on IDX and false is
7769 returned. */
7771 static bool
7772 find_case_label_index (gswitch *stmt, size_t start_idx, tree val, size_t *idx)
7774 size_t n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
7775 size_t low, high;
7777 /* Find case label for minimum of the value range or the next one.
7778 At each iteration we are searching in [low, high - 1]. */
7780 for (low = start_idx, high = n; high != low; )
7782 tree t;
7783 int cmp;
7784 /* Note that i != high, so we never ask for n. */
7785 size_t i = (high + low) / 2;
7786 t = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
7788 /* Cache the result of comparing CASE_LOW and val. */
7789 cmp = tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (t), val);
7791 if (cmp == 0)
7793 /* Ranges cannot be empty. */
7794 *idx = i;
7795 return true;
7797 else if (cmp > 0)
7798 high = i;
7799 else
7801 low = i + 1;
7802 if (CASE_HIGH (t) != NULL
7803 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (t), val) >= 0)
7805 *idx = i;
7806 return true;
7811 *idx = high;
7812 return false;
7815 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the range of CASE_LABELs that is used
7816 for values between MIN and MAX. The first index is placed in MIN_IDX. The
7817 last index is placed in MAX_IDX. If the range of CASE_LABELs is empty
7818 then MAX_IDX < MIN_IDX.
7819 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
7821 static bool
7822 find_case_label_range (gswitch *stmt, tree min, tree max, size_t *min_idx,
7823 size_t *max_idx)
7825 size_t i, j;
7826 bool min_take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, 1, min, &i);
7827 bool max_take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, i, max, &j);
7829 if (i == j
7830 && min_take_default
7831 && max_take_default)
7833 /* Only the default case label reached.
7834 Return an empty range. */
7835 *min_idx = 1;
7836 *max_idx = 0;
7837 return false;
7839 else
7841 bool take_default = min_take_default || max_take_default;
7842 tree low, high;
7843 size_t k;
7845 if (max_take_default)
7846 j--;
7848 /* If the case label range is continuous, we do not need
7849 the default case label. Verify that. */
7850 high = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7851 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i)))
7852 high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7853 for (k = i + 1; k <= j; ++k)
7855 low = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k));
7856 if (!integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, low, high)))
7858 take_default = true;
7859 break;
7861 high = low;
7862 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k)))
7863 high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k));
7866 *min_idx = i;
7867 *max_idx = j;
7868 return !take_default;
7872 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the ranges of CASE_LABELs that are
7873 used in range VR. The indices are placed in MIN_IDX1, MAX_IDX, MIN_IDX2 and
7874 MAX_IDX2. If the ranges of CASE_LABELs are empty then MAX_IDX1 < MIN_IDX1.
7875 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
7877 static bool
7878 find_case_label_ranges (gswitch *stmt, value_range *vr, size_t *min_idx1,
7879 size_t *max_idx1, size_t *min_idx2,
7880 size_t *max_idx2)
7882 size_t i, j, k, l;
7883 unsigned int n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
7884 bool take_default;
7885 tree case_low, case_high;
7886 tree min = vr->min, max = vr->max;
7888 gcc_checking_assert (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE);
7890 take_default = !find_case_label_range (stmt, min, max, &i, &j);
7892 /* Set second range to emtpy. */
7893 *min_idx2 = 1;
7894 *max_idx2 = 0;
7896 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
7898 *min_idx1 = i;
7899 *max_idx1 = j;
7900 return !take_default;
7903 /* Set first range to all case labels. */
7904 *min_idx1 = 1;
7905 *max_idx1 = n - 1;
7907 if (i > j)
7908 return false;
7910 /* Make sure all the values of case labels [i , j] are contained in
7911 range [MIN, MAX]. */
7912 case_low = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7913 case_high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, j));
7914 if (tree_int_cst_compare (case_low, min) < 0)
7915 i += 1;
7916 if (case_high != NULL_TREE
7917 && tree_int_cst_compare (max, case_high) < 0)
7918 j -= 1;
7920 if (i > j)
7921 return false;
7923 /* If the range spans case labels [i, j], the corresponding anti-range spans
7924 the labels [1, i - 1] and [j + 1, n - 1]. */
7925 k = j + 1;
7926 l = n - 1;
7927 if (k > l)
7929 k = 1;
7930 l = 0;
7933 j = i - 1;
7934 i = 1;
7935 if (i > j)
7937 i = k;
7938 j = l;
7939 k = 1;
7940 l = 0;
7943 *min_idx1 = i;
7944 *max_idx1 = j;
7945 *min_idx2 = k;
7946 *max_idx2 = l;
7947 return false;
7950 /* Visit switch statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
7951 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
7952 *TAKEN_EDGE_P. Otherwise, *TAKEN_EDGE_P set to NULL. */
7954 static void
7955 vrp_visit_switch_stmt (gswitch *stmt, edge *taken_edge_p)
7957 tree op, val;
7958 value_range *vr;
7959 size_t i = 0, j = 0, k, l;
7960 bool take_default;
7962 *taken_edge_p = NULL;
7963 op = gimple_switch_index (stmt);
7964 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
7965 return;
7967 vr = get_value_range (op);
7968 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7970 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting switch expression with operand ");
7971 print_generic_expr (dump_file, op, 0);
7972 fprintf (dump_file, " with known range ");
7973 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr);
7974 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7977 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE
7978 && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7979 || symbolic_range_p (vr))
7980 return;
7982 /* Find the single edge that is taken from the switch expression. */
7983 take_default = !find_case_label_ranges (stmt, vr, &i, &j, &k, &l);
7985 /* Check if the range spans no CASE_LABEL. If so, we only reach the default
7986 label */
7987 if (j < i)
7989 gcc_assert (take_default);
7990 val = gimple_switch_default_label (stmt);
7992 else
7994 /* Check if labels with index i to j and maybe the default label
7995 are all reaching the same label. */
7997 val = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
7998 if (take_default
7999 && CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_default_label (stmt))
8000 != CASE_LABEL (val))
8002 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8003 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
8004 "range\n");
8005 return;
8007 for (++i; i <= j; ++i)
8009 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i)) != CASE_LABEL (val))
8011 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8012 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
8013 "range\n");
8014 return;
8017 for (; k <= l; ++k)
8019 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k)) != CASE_LABEL (val))
8021 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8022 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
8023 "range\n");
8024 return;
8029 *taken_edge_p = find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt),
8030 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (val)));
8032 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8034 fprintf (dump_file, " will take edge to ");
8035 print_generic_stmt (dump_file, CASE_LABEL (val), 0);
8040 /* Evaluate statement STMT. If the statement produces a useful range,
8041 set VR and corepsponding OUTPUT_P.
8043 If STMT is a conditional branch and we can determine its truth
8044 value, the taken edge is recorded in *TAKEN_EDGE_P. */
8046 static void
8047 extract_range_from_stmt (gimple *stmt, edge *taken_edge_p,
8048 tree *output_p, value_range *vr)
8051 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8053 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting statement:\n");
8054 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, dump_flags);
8057 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt))
8058 gcc_assert (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt));
8059 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt) || is_gimple_call (stmt))
8060 vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (stmt, output_p, vr);
8061 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
8062 vrp_visit_cond_stmt (as_a <gcond *> (stmt), taken_edge_p);
8063 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
8064 vrp_visit_switch_stmt (as_a <gswitch *> (stmt), taken_edge_p);
8067 /* Evaluate statement STMT. If the statement produces a useful range,
8068 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING and record the SSA name with the
8069 interesting range into *OUTPUT_P.
8071 If STMT is a conditional branch and we can determine its truth
8072 value, the taken edge is recorded in *TAKEN_EDGE_P.
8074 If STMT produces a varying value, return SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
8076 static enum ssa_prop_result
8077 vrp_visit_stmt (gimple *stmt, edge *taken_edge_p, tree *output_p)
8079 value_range vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
8080 tree lhs = gimple_get_lhs (stmt);
8081 extract_range_from_stmt (stmt, taken_edge_p, output_p, &vr);
8083 if (*output_p)
8085 if (update_value_range (*output_p, &vr))
8087 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8089 fprintf (dump_file, "Found new range for ");
8090 print_generic_expr (dump_file, *output_p, 0);
8091 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
8092 dump_value_range (dump_file, &vr);
8093 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8096 if (vr.type == VR_VARYING)
8097 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
8099 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
8101 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING;
8104 if (is_gimple_call (stmt) && gimple_call_internal_p (stmt))
8105 switch (gimple_call_internal_fn (stmt))
8107 case IFN_ADD_OVERFLOW:
8108 case IFN_SUB_OVERFLOW:
8109 case IFN_MUL_OVERFLOW:
8110 /* These internal calls return _Complex integer type,
8111 which VRP does not track, but the immediate uses
8112 thereof might be interesting. */
8113 if (lhs && TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME)
8115 imm_use_iterator iter;
8116 use_operand_p use_p;
8117 enum ssa_prop_result res = SSA_PROP_VARYING;
8119 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (lhs));
8121 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_FAST (use_p, iter, lhs)
8123 gimple *use_stmt = USE_STMT (use_p);
8124 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt))
8125 continue;
8126 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt);
8127 if (rhs_code != REALPART_EXPR && rhs_code != IMAGPART_EXPR)
8128 continue;
8129 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (use_stmt);
8130 tree use_lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt);
8131 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) != rhs_code
8132 || TREE_OPERAND (rhs1, 0) != lhs
8133 || TREE_CODE (use_lhs) != SSA_NAME
8134 || !stmt_interesting_for_vrp (use_stmt)
8135 || (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (use_lhs))
8136 || !TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (use_lhs))
8137 || !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (use_lhs))))
8138 continue;
8140 /* If there is a change in the value range for any of the
8141 REALPART_EXPR/IMAGPART_EXPR immediate uses, return
8142 SSA_PROP_INTERESTING. If there are any REALPART_EXPR
8143 or IMAGPART_EXPR immediate uses, but none of them have
8144 a change in their value ranges, return
8145 SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING. If there are no
8146 {REAL,IMAG}PART_EXPR uses at all,
8147 return SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
8148 value_range new_vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
8149 extract_range_basic (&new_vr, use_stmt);
8150 value_range *old_vr = get_value_range (use_lhs);
8151 if (old_vr->type != new_vr.type
8152 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->min, new_vr.min)
8153 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->max, new_vr.max)
8154 || !vrp_bitmap_equal_p (old_vr->equiv, new_vr.equiv))
8155 res = SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
8156 else
8157 res = SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING;
8158 BITMAP_FREE (new_vr.equiv);
8159 if (res == SSA_PROP_INTERESTING)
8161 *output_p = lhs;
8162 return res;
8166 return res;
8168 break;
8169 default:
8170 break;
8173 /* All other statements produce nothing of interest for VRP, so mark
8174 their outputs varying and prevent further simulation. */
8175 set_defs_to_varying (stmt);
8177 return (*taken_edge_p) ? SSA_PROP_INTERESTING : SSA_PROP_VARYING;
8180 /* Union the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
8181 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
8182 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
8183 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
8185 static void
8186 union_ranges (enum value_range_type *vr0type,
8187 tree *vr0min, tree *vr0max,
8188 enum value_range_type vr1type,
8189 tree vr1min, tree vr1max)
8191 bool mineq = vrp_operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1min);
8192 bool maxeq = vrp_operand_equal_p (*vr0max, vr1max);
8194 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
8195 if (mineq && maxeq)
8197 /* [( )] */
8198 if (*vr0type == vr1type)
8199 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
8201 else if ((*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8202 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8203 || (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8204 && vr1type == VR_RANGE))
8206 /* For anti-range with range union the result is varying. */
8207 goto give_up;
8209 else
8210 gcc_unreachable ();
8212 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
8213 || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1)
8215 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
8216 If the ranges have an empty intersection, result of the union
8217 operation is the anti-range or if both are anti-ranges
8218 it covers all. */
8219 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8220 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8221 goto give_up;
8222 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8223 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8225 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8226 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8228 *vr0type = vr1type;
8229 *vr0min = vr1min;
8230 *vr0max = vr1max;
8232 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8233 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8235 /* The result is the convex hull of both ranges. */
8236 if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1)
8238 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
8239 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST
8240 && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST
8241 && vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min)
8242 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max))
8244 tree min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
8245 *vr0max,
8246 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0max), 1));
8247 tree max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
8248 vr1min,
8249 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1min), 1));
8250 if (!operand_less_p (max, min))
8252 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
8253 *vr0min = min;
8254 *vr0max = max;
8256 else
8257 *vr0max = vr1max;
8259 else
8260 *vr0max = vr1max;
8262 else
8264 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
8265 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST
8266 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST
8267 && vrp_val_is_min (vr1min)
8268 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max))
8270 tree min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
8271 vr1max,
8272 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1max), 1));
8273 tree max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
8274 *vr0min,
8275 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0min), 1));
8276 if (!operand_less_p (max, min))
8278 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
8279 *vr0min = min;
8280 *vr0max = max;
8282 else
8283 *vr0min = vr1min;
8285 else
8286 *vr0min = vr1min;
8289 else
8290 gcc_unreachable ();
8292 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
8293 && (mineq || operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1))
8295 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
8296 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8297 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8299 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8300 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8302 *vr0type = vr1type;
8303 *vr0min = vr1min;
8304 *vr0max = vr1max;
8306 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8307 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8309 /* Arbitrarily choose the right or left gap. */
8310 if (!mineq && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
8311 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
8312 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1min), 1));
8313 else if (!maxeq && TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
8314 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max,
8315 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1max), 1));
8316 else
8317 goto give_up;
8319 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8320 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8321 /* The result covers everything. */
8322 goto give_up;
8323 else
8324 gcc_unreachable ();
8326 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
8327 && (mineq || operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1))
8329 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
8330 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8331 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8333 *vr0type = vr1type;
8334 *vr0min = vr1min;
8335 *vr0max = vr1max;
8337 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8338 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8340 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8341 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8343 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
8344 if (!mineq && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
8346 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
8347 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0min), 1));
8348 *vr0min = vr1min;
8350 else if (!maxeq && TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
8352 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
8353 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0max), 1));
8354 *vr0max = vr1max;
8356 else
8357 goto give_up;
8359 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8360 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8361 /* The result covers everything. */
8362 goto give_up;
8363 else
8364 gcc_unreachable ();
8366 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0max) == 1
8367 || operand_equal_p (vr1min, *vr0max, 0))
8368 && operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1
8369 && operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
8371 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
8372 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8373 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8374 *vr0max = vr1max;
8375 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8376 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8377 *vr0min = vr1min;
8378 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8379 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8381 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
8382 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
8383 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1min), 1));
8384 else
8385 goto give_up;
8387 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8388 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8390 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
8392 *vr0type = vr1type;
8393 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
8394 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0max), 1));
8395 *vr0max = vr1max;
8397 else
8398 goto give_up;
8400 else
8401 gcc_unreachable ();
8403 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1max) == 1
8404 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1max, 0))
8405 && operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1
8406 && operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
8408 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
8409 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8410 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8411 *vr0min = vr1min;
8412 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8413 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8414 *vr0max = vr1max;
8415 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8416 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8418 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
8419 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max,
8420 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1max), 1));
8421 else
8422 goto give_up;
8424 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8425 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8427 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
8429 *vr0type = vr1type;
8430 *vr0min = vr1min;
8431 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
8432 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0min), 1));
8434 else
8435 goto give_up;
8437 else
8438 gcc_unreachable ();
8440 else
8441 goto give_up;
8443 return;
8445 give_up:
8446 *vr0type = VR_VARYING;
8447 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
8448 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
8451 /* Intersect the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
8452 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
8453 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
8454 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
8456 static void
8457 intersect_ranges (enum value_range_type *vr0type,
8458 tree *vr0min, tree *vr0max,
8459 enum value_range_type vr1type,
8460 tree vr1min, tree vr1max)
8462 bool mineq = vrp_operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1min);
8463 bool maxeq = vrp_operand_equal_p (*vr0max, vr1max);
8465 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
8466 if (mineq && maxeq)
8468 /* [( )] */
8469 if (*vr0type == vr1type)
8470 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
8472 else if ((*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8473 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8474 || (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8475 && vr1type == VR_RANGE))
8477 /* For anti-range with range intersection the result is empty. */
8478 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
8479 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
8480 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
8482 else
8483 gcc_unreachable ();
8485 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
8486 || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1)
8488 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
8489 If the ranges have an empty intersection, the result of the
8490 intersect operation is the range for intersecting an
8491 anti-range with a range or empty when intersecting two ranges. */
8492 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8493 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8495 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8496 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8498 *vr0type = vr1type;
8499 *vr0min = vr1min;
8500 *vr0max = vr1max;
8502 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8503 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8505 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
8506 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
8507 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
8509 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8510 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8512 /* If the anti-ranges are adjacent to each other merge them. */
8513 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST
8514 && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST
8515 && operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
8516 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
8517 vr1min, *vr0max)))
8518 *vr0max = vr1max;
8519 else if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST
8520 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST
8521 && operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1
8522 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
8523 *vr0min, vr1max)))
8524 *vr0min = vr1min;
8525 /* Else arbitrarily take VR0. */
8528 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
8529 && (mineq || operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1))
8531 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
8532 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8533 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8535 /* If both are ranges the result is the inner one. */
8536 *vr0type = vr1type;
8537 *vr0min = vr1min;
8538 *vr0max = vr1max;
8540 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8541 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8543 /* Choose the right gap if the left one is empty. */
8544 if (mineq)
8546 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
8547 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max,
8548 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1max), 1));
8549 else
8550 *vr0min = vr1max;
8552 /* Choose the left gap if the right one is empty. */
8553 else if (maxeq)
8555 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
8556 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
8557 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1min), 1));
8558 else
8559 *vr0max = vr1min;
8561 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
8562 else if (vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min)
8563 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max))
8565 *vr0type = vr1type;
8566 *vr0min = vr1min;
8567 *vr0max = vr1max;
8569 /* Else choose the range. */
8571 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8572 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8573 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
8575 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8576 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8578 /* The intersection is empty. */
8579 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
8580 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
8581 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
8583 else
8584 gcc_unreachable ();
8586 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
8587 && (mineq || operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1))
8589 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
8590 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8591 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8592 /* Choose the inner range. */
8594 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8595 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8597 /* Choose the right gap if the left is empty. */
8598 if (mineq)
8600 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
8601 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
8602 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
8603 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0max), 1));
8604 else
8605 *vr0min = *vr0max;
8606 *vr0max = vr1max;
8608 /* Choose the left gap if the right is empty. */
8609 else if (maxeq)
8611 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
8612 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
8613 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
8614 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0min), 1));
8615 else
8616 *vr0max = *vr0min;
8617 *vr0min = vr1min;
8619 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
8620 else if (vrp_val_is_min (vr1min)
8621 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max))
8623 /* Else choose the range. */
8624 else
8626 *vr0type = vr1type;
8627 *vr0min = vr1min;
8628 *vr0max = vr1max;
8631 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8632 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8634 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
8635 *vr0type = vr1type;
8636 *vr0min = vr1min;
8637 *vr0max = vr1max;
8639 else if (vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8640 && *vr0type == VR_RANGE)
8642 /* The intersection is empty. */
8643 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
8644 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
8645 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
8647 else
8648 gcc_unreachable ();
8650 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0max) == 1
8651 || operand_equal_p (vr1min, *vr0max, 0))
8652 && operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1)
8654 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
8655 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8656 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8657 *vr0max = vr1max;
8658 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8659 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8660 *vr0min = vr1min;
8661 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8662 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8664 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
8665 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
8666 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1min), 1));
8667 else
8668 *vr0max = vr1min;
8670 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8671 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8673 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
8674 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
8675 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
8676 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0max), 1));
8677 else
8678 *vr0min = *vr0max;
8679 *vr0max = vr1max;
8681 else
8682 gcc_unreachable ();
8684 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1max) == 1
8685 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1max, 0))
8686 && operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1)
8688 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
8689 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8690 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8691 *vr0min = vr1min;
8692 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8693 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8694 *vr0max = vr1max;
8695 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
8696 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8698 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
8699 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max,
8700 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr1max), 1));
8701 else
8702 *vr0min = vr1max;
8704 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8705 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
8707 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
8708 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
8709 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
8710 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (*vr0min), 1));
8711 else
8712 *vr0max = *vr0min;
8713 *vr0min = vr1min;
8715 else
8716 gcc_unreachable ();
8719 /* As a fallback simply use { *VRTYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } as
8720 result for the intersection. That's always a conservative
8721 correct estimate unless VR1 is a constant singleton range
8722 in which case we choose that. */
8723 if (vr1type == VR_RANGE
8724 && is_gimple_min_invariant (vr1min)
8725 && vrp_operand_equal_p (vr1min, vr1max))
8727 *vr0type = vr1type;
8728 *vr0min = vr1min;
8729 *vr0max = vr1max;
8732 return;
8736 /* Intersect the two value-ranges *VR0 and *VR1 and store the result
8737 in *VR0. This may not be the smallest possible such range. */
8739 static void
8740 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1)
8742 value_range saved;
8744 /* If either range is VR_VARYING the other one wins. */
8745 if (vr1->type == VR_VARYING)
8746 return;
8747 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
8749 copy_value_range (vr0, vr1);
8750 return;
8753 /* When either range is VR_UNDEFINED the resulting range is
8754 VR_UNDEFINED, too. */
8755 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8756 return;
8757 if (vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8759 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr0);
8760 return;
8763 /* Save the original vr0 so we can return it as conservative intersection
8764 result when our worker turns things to varying. */
8765 saved = *vr0;
8766 intersect_ranges (&vr0->type, &vr0->min, &vr0->max,
8767 vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max);
8768 /* Make sure to canonicalize the result though as the inversion of a
8769 VR_RANGE can still be a VR_RANGE. */
8770 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0, vr0->type,
8771 vr0->min, vr0->max, vr0->equiv);
8772 /* If that failed, use the saved original VR0. */
8773 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
8775 *vr0 = saved;
8776 return;
8778 /* If the result is VR_UNDEFINED there is no need to mess with
8779 the equivalencies. */
8780 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8781 return;
8783 /* The resulting set of equivalences for range intersection is the union of
8784 the two sets. */
8785 if (vr0->equiv && vr1->equiv && vr0->equiv != vr1->equiv)
8786 bitmap_ior_into (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
8787 else if (vr1->equiv && !vr0->equiv)
8789 vr0->equiv = BITMAP_ALLOC (&vrp_equiv_obstack);
8790 bitmap_copy (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
8794 void
8795 vrp_intersect_ranges (value_range *vr0, value_range *vr1)
8797 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8799 fprintf (dump_file, "Intersecting\n ");
8800 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
8801 fprintf (dump_file, "\nand\n ");
8802 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr1);
8803 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8805 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (vr0, vr1);
8806 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8808 fprintf (dump_file, "to\n ");
8809 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
8810 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8814 /* Meet operation for value ranges. Given two value ranges VR0 and
8815 VR1, store in VR0 a range that contains both VR0 and VR1. This
8816 may not be the smallest possible such range. */
8818 static void
8819 vrp_meet_1 (value_range *vr0, const value_range *vr1)
8821 value_range saved;
8823 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8825 set_value_range (vr0, vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max, vr1->equiv);
8826 return;
8829 if (vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8831 /* VR0 already has the resulting range. */
8832 return;
8835 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
8837 /* Nothing to do. VR0 already has the resulting range. */
8838 return;
8841 if (vr1->type == VR_VARYING)
8843 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0);
8844 return;
8847 saved = *vr0;
8848 union_ranges (&vr0->type, &vr0->min, &vr0->max,
8849 vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max);
8850 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
8852 /* Failed to find an efficient meet. Before giving up and setting
8853 the result to VARYING, see if we can at least derive a useful
8854 anti-range. FIXME, all this nonsense about distinguishing
8855 anti-ranges from ranges is necessary because of the odd
8856 semantics of range_includes_zero_p and friends. */
8857 if (((saved.type == VR_RANGE
8858 && range_includes_zero_p (saved.min, saved.max) == 0)
8859 || (saved.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8860 && range_includes_zero_p (saved.min, saved.max) == 1))
8861 && ((vr1->type == VR_RANGE
8862 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1->min, vr1->max) == 0)
8863 || (vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
8864 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1->min, vr1->max) == 1)))
8866 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr0, TREE_TYPE (saved.min));
8868 /* Since this meet operation did not result from the meeting of
8869 two equivalent names, VR0 cannot have any equivalences. */
8870 if (vr0->equiv)
8871 bitmap_clear (vr0->equiv);
8872 return;
8875 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0);
8876 return;
8878 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0, vr0->type, vr0->min, vr0->max,
8879 vr0->equiv);
8880 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
8881 return;
8883 /* The resulting set of equivalences is always the intersection of
8884 the two sets. */
8885 if (vr0->equiv && vr1->equiv && vr0->equiv != vr1->equiv)
8886 bitmap_and_into (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
8887 else if (vr0->equiv && !vr1->equiv)
8888 bitmap_clear (vr0->equiv);
8891 void
8892 vrp_meet (value_range *vr0, const value_range *vr1)
8894 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8896 fprintf (dump_file, "Meeting\n ");
8897 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
8898 fprintf (dump_file, "\nand\n ");
8899 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr1);
8900 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8902 vrp_meet_1 (vr0, vr1);
8903 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8905 fprintf (dump_file, "to\n ");
8906 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
8907 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8912 /* Visit all arguments for PHI node PHI that flow through executable
8913 edges. If a valid value range can be derived from all the incoming
8914 value ranges, set a new range in VR_RESULT. */
8916 static void
8917 extract_range_from_phi_node (gphi *phi, value_range *vr_result)
8919 size_t i;
8920 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
8921 value_range *lhs_vr = get_value_range (lhs);
8922 bool first = true;
8923 int edges, old_edges;
8924 struct loop *l;
8926 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8928 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting PHI node: ");
8929 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, phi, 0, dump_flags);
8932 bool may_simulate_backedge_again = false;
8933 edges = 0;
8934 for (i = 0; i < gimple_phi_num_args (phi); i++)
8936 edge e = gimple_phi_arg_edge (phi, i);
8938 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8940 fprintf (dump_file,
8941 " Argument #%d (%d -> %d %sexecutable)\n",
8942 (int) i, e->src->index, e->dest->index,
8943 (e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE) ? "" : "not ");
8946 if (e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE)
8948 tree arg = PHI_ARG_DEF (phi, i);
8949 value_range vr_arg;
8951 ++edges;
8953 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
8955 /* See if we are eventually going to change one of the args. */
8956 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (arg);
8957 if (! gimple_nop_p (def_stmt)
8958 && prop_simulate_again_p (def_stmt)
8959 && e->flags & EDGE_DFS_BACK)
8960 may_simulate_backedge_again = true;
8962 vr_arg = *(get_value_range (arg));
8963 /* Do not allow equivalences or symbolic ranges to leak in from
8964 backedges. That creates invalid equivalencies.
8965 See PR53465 and PR54767. */
8966 if (e->flags & EDGE_DFS_BACK)
8968 if (vr_arg.type == VR_RANGE
8969 || vr_arg.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8971 vr_arg.equiv = NULL;
8972 if (symbolic_range_p (&vr_arg))
8974 vr_arg.type = VR_VARYING;
8975 vr_arg.min = NULL_TREE;
8976 vr_arg.max = NULL_TREE;
8980 else
8982 /* If the non-backedge arguments range is VR_VARYING then
8983 we can still try recording a simple equivalence. */
8984 if (vr_arg.type == VR_VARYING)
8986 vr_arg.type = VR_RANGE;
8987 vr_arg.min = arg;
8988 vr_arg.max = arg;
8989 vr_arg.equiv = NULL;
8993 else
8995 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (arg))
8996 arg = drop_tree_overflow (arg);
8998 vr_arg.type = VR_RANGE;
8999 vr_arg.min = arg;
9000 vr_arg.max = arg;
9001 vr_arg.equiv = NULL;
9004 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9006 fprintf (dump_file, "\t");
9007 print_generic_expr (dump_file, arg, dump_flags);
9008 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
9009 dump_value_range (dump_file, &vr_arg);
9010 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9013 if (first)
9014 copy_value_range (vr_result, &vr_arg);
9015 else
9016 vrp_meet (vr_result, &vr_arg);
9017 first = false;
9019 if (vr_result->type == VR_VARYING)
9020 break;
9024 if (vr_result->type == VR_VARYING)
9025 goto varying;
9026 else if (vr_result->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
9027 goto update_range;
9029 old_edges = vr_phi_edge_counts[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs)];
9030 vr_phi_edge_counts[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs)] = edges;
9032 /* To prevent infinite iterations in the algorithm, derive ranges
9033 when the new value is slightly bigger or smaller than the
9034 previous one. We don't do this if we have seen a new executable
9035 edge; this helps us avoid an overflow infinity for conditionals
9036 which are not in a loop. If the old value-range was VR_UNDEFINED
9037 use the updated range and iterate one more time. If we will not
9038 simulate this PHI again via the backedge allow us to iterate. */
9039 if (edges > 0
9040 && gimple_phi_num_args (phi) > 1
9041 && edges == old_edges
9042 && lhs_vr->type != VR_UNDEFINED
9043 && may_simulate_backedge_again)
9045 /* Compare old and new ranges, fall back to varying if the
9046 values are not comparable. */
9047 int cmp_min = compare_values (lhs_vr->min, vr_result->min);
9048 if (cmp_min == -2)
9049 goto varying;
9050 int cmp_max = compare_values (lhs_vr->max, vr_result->max);
9051 if (cmp_max == -2)
9052 goto varying;
9054 /* For non VR_RANGE or for pointers fall back to varying if
9055 the range changed. */
9056 if ((lhs_vr->type != VR_RANGE || vr_result->type != VR_RANGE
9057 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
9058 && (cmp_min != 0 || cmp_max != 0))
9059 goto varying;
9061 /* If the new minimum is larger than the previous one
9062 retain the old value. If the new minimum value is smaller
9063 than the previous one and not -INF go all the way to -INF + 1.
9064 In the first case, to avoid infinite bouncing between different
9065 minimums, and in the other case to avoid iterating millions of
9066 times to reach -INF. Going to -INF + 1 also lets the following
9067 iteration compute whether there will be any overflow, at the
9068 expense of one additional iteration. */
9069 if (cmp_min < 0)
9070 vr_result->min = lhs_vr->min;
9071 else if (cmp_min > 0
9072 && !vrp_val_is_min (vr_result->min))
9073 vr_result->min
9074 = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
9075 vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (vr_result->min)),
9076 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr_result->min), 1));
9078 /* Similarly for the maximum value. */
9079 if (cmp_max > 0)
9080 vr_result->max = lhs_vr->max;
9081 else if (cmp_max < 0
9082 && !vrp_val_is_max (vr_result->max))
9083 vr_result->max
9084 = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
9085 vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (vr_result->min)),
9086 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr_result->min), 1));
9088 /* If we dropped either bound to +-INF then if this is a loop
9089 PHI node SCEV may known more about its value-range. */
9090 if (cmp_min > 0 || cmp_min < 0
9091 || cmp_max < 0 || cmp_max > 0)
9092 goto scev_check;
9094 goto infinite_check;
9097 goto update_range;
9099 varying:
9100 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_result);
9102 scev_check:
9103 /* If this is a loop PHI node SCEV may known more about its value-range.
9104 scev_check can be reached from two paths, one is a fall through from above
9105 "varying" label, the other is direct goto from code block which tries to
9106 avoid infinite simulation. */
9107 if ((l = loop_containing_stmt (phi))
9108 && l->header == gimple_bb (phi))
9109 adjust_range_with_scev (vr_result, l, phi, lhs);
9111 infinite_check:
9112 /* If we will end up with a (-INF, +INF) range, set it to
9113 VARYING. Same if the previous max value was invalid for
9114 the type and we end up with vr_result.min > vr_result.max. */
9115 if ((vr_result->type == VR_RANGE || vr_result->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
9116 && !((vrp_val_is_max (vr_result->max) && vrp_val_is_min (vr_result->min))
9117 || compare_values (vr_result->min, vr_result->max) > 0))
9119 else
9120 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_result);
9122 /* If the new range is different than the previous value, keep
9123 iterating. */
9124 update_range:
9125 return;
9128 /* Visit all arguments for PHI node PHI that flow through executable
9129 edges. If a valid value range can be derived from all the incoming
9130 value ranges, set a new range for the LHS of PHI. */
9132 static enum ssa_prop_result
9133 vrp_visit_phi_node (gphi *phi)
9135 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
9136 value_range vr_result = VR_INITIALIZER;
9137 extract_range_from_phi_node (phi, &vr_result);
9138 if (update_value_range (lhs, &vr_result))
9140 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9142 fprintf (dump_file, "Found new range for ");
9143 print_generic_expr (dump_file, lhs, 0);
9144 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
9145 dump_value_range (dump_file, &vr_result);
9146 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9149 if (vr_result.type == VR_VARYING)
9150 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
9152 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
9155 /* Nothing changed, don't add outgoing edges. */
9156 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING;
9159 /* Simplify boolean operations if the source is known
9160 to be already a boolean. */
9161 static bool
9162 simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
9164 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
9165 tree lhs, op0, op1;
9166 bool need_conversion;
9168 /* We handle only !=/== case here. */
9169 gcc_assert (rhs_code == EQ_EXPR || rhs_code == NE_EXPR);
9171 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
9172 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op0))
9173 return false;
9175 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
9176 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op1))
9177 return false;
9179 /* Reduce number of cases to handle to NE_EXPR. As there is no
9180 BIT_XNOR_EXPR we cannot replace A == B with a single statement. */
9181 if (rhs_code == EQ_EXPR)
9183 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST)
9184 op1 = int_const_binop (BIT_XOR_EXPR, op1,
9185 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op1), 1));
9186 else
9187 return false;
9190 lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (stmt);
9191 need_conversion
9192 = !useless_type_conversion_p (TREE_TYPE (lhs), TREE_TYPE (op0));
9194 /* Make sure to not sign-extend a 1-bit 1 when converting the result. */
9195 if (need_conversion
9196 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0))
9197 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op0)) == 1
9198 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (lhs)) > 1)
9199 return false;
9201 /* For A != 0 we can substitute A itself. */
9202 if (integer_zerop (op1))
9203 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi,
9204 need_conversion
9205 ? NOP_EXPR : TREE_CODE (op0), op0);
9206 /* For A != B we substitute A ^ B. Either with conversion. */
9207 else if (need_conversion)
9209 tree tem = make_ssa_name (TREE_TYPE (op0));
9210 gassign *newop
9211 = gimple_build_assign (tem, BIT_XOR_EXPR, op0, op1);
9212 gsi_insert_before (gsi, newop, GSI_SAME_STMT);
9213 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9214 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (tem)) > 1)
9215 set_range_info (tem, VR_RANGE,
9216 wi::zero (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (tem))),
9217 wi::one (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (tem))));
9218 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, NOP_EXPR, tem);
9220 /* Or without. */
9221 else
9222 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, BIT_XOR_EXPR, op0, op1);
9223 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi));
9224 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
9226 return true;
9229 /* Simplify a division or modulo operator to a right shift or bitwise and
9230 if the first operand is unsigned or is greater than zero and the second
9231 operand is an exact power of two. For TRUNC_MOD_EXPR op0 % op1 with
9232 constant op1 (op1min = op1) or with op1 in [op1min, op1max] range,
9233 optimize it into just op0 if op0's range is known to be a subset of
9234 [-op1min + 1, op1min - 1] for signed and [0, op1min - 1] for unsigned
9235 modulo. */
9237 static bool
9238 simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
9240 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
9241 tree val = NULL;
9242 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
9243 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
9244 tree op1min = op1;
9245 value_range *vr = get_value_range (op0);
9247 if (rhs_code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
9248 && TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
9250 value_range *vr1 = get_value_range (op1);
9251 if (range_int_cst_p (vr1))
9252 op1min = vr1->min;
9254 if (rhs_code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
9255 && TREE_CODE (op1min) == INTEGER_CST
9256 && tree_int_cst_sgn (op1min) == 1
9257 && range_int_cst_p (vr)
9258 && tree_int_cst_lt (vr->max, op1min))
9260 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0))
9261 || tree_int_cst_sgn (vr->min) >= 0
9262 || tree_int_cst_lt (fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (op1min), op1min),
9263 vr->min))
9265 /* If op0 already has the range op0 % op1 has,
9266 then TRUNC_MOD_EXPR won't change anything. */
9267 gimple_assign_set_rhs_from_tree (gsi, op0);
9268 return true;
9272 if (!integer_pow2p (op1))
9274 /* X % -Y can be only optimized into X % Y either if
9275 X is not INT_MIN, or Y is not -1. Fold it now, as after
9276 remove_range_assertions the range info might be not available
9277 anymore. */
9278 if (rhs_code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
9279 && fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges))
9280 return true;
9281 return false;
9284 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0)))
9285 val = integer_one_node;
9286 else
9288 bool sop = false;
9290 val = compare_range_with_value (GE_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node, &sop);
9292 if (val
9293 && sop
9294 && integer_onep (val)
9295 && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC))
9297 location_t location;
9299 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
9300 location = input_location;
9301 else
9302 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9303 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9304 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9305 "simplifying %</%> or %<%%%> to %<>>%> or %<&%>");
9309 if (val && integer_onep (val))
9311 tree t;
9313 if (rhs_code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR)
9315 t = build_int_cst (integer_type_node, tree_log2 (op1));
9316 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, RSHIFT_EXPR);
9317 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op0);
9318 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt, t);
9320 else
9322 t = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op1), 1);
9323 t = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, op1, t);
9324 t = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op0), t);
9326 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, BIT_AND_EXPR);
9327 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op0);
9328 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt, t);
9331 update_stmt (stmt);
9332 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
9333 return true;
9336 return false;
9339 /* Simplify a min or max if the ranges of the two operands are
9340 disjoint. Return true if we do simplify. */
9342 static bool
9343 simplify_min_or_max_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
9345 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
9346 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
9347 bool sop = false;
9348 tree val;
9350 val = (vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges
9351 (LE_EXPR, op0, op1, &sop));
9352 if (!val)
9354 sop = false;
9355 val = (vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges
9356 (LT_EXPR, op0, op1, &sop));
9359 if (val)
9361 if (sop && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC))
9363 location_t location;
9365 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
9366 location = input_location;
9367 else
9368 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9369 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9370 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9371 "simplifying %<min/max (X,Y)%> to %<X%> or %<Y%>");
9374 /* VAL == TRUE -> OP0 < or <= op1
9375 VAL == FALSE -> OP0 > or >= op1. */
9376 tree res = ((gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == MAX_EXPR)
9377 == integer_zerop (val)) ? op0 : op1;
9378 gimple_assign_set_rhs_from_tree (gsi, res);
9379 return true;
9382 return false;
9385 /* If the operand to an ABS_EXPR is >= 0, then eliminate the
9386 ABS_EXPR. If the operand is <= 0, then simplify the
9387 ABS_EXPR into a NEGATE_EXPR. */
9389 static bool
9390 simplify_abs_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
9392 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
9393 value_range *vr = get_value_range (op);
9395 if (vr)
9397 tree val = NULL;
9398 bool sop = false;
9400 val = compare_range_with_value (LE_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node, &sop);
9401 if (!val)
9403 /* The range is neither <= 0 nor > 0. Now see if it is
9404 either < 0 or >= 0. */
9405 sop = false;
9406 val = compare_range_with_value (LT_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node,
9407 &sop);
9410 if (val)
9412 if (sop && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC))
9414 location_t location;
9416 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
9417 location = input_location;
9418 else
9419 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9420 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9421 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9422 "simplifying %<abs (X)%> to %<X%> or %<-X%>");
9425 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op);
9426 if (integer_zerop (val))
9427 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, SSA_NAME);
9428 else
9429 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, NEGATE_EXPR);
9430 update_stmt (stmt);
9431 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
9432 return true;
9436 return false;
9439 /* Optimize away redundant BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR.
9440 If all the bits that are being cleared by & are already
9441 known to be zero from VR, or all the bits that are being
9442 set by | are already known to be one from VR, the bit
9443 operation is redundant. */
9445 static bool
9446 simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
9448 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
9449 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
9450 tree op = NULL_TREE;
9451 value_range vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
9452 value_range vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
9453 wide_int may_be_nonzero0, may_be_nonzero1;
9454 wide_int must_be_nonzero0, must_be_nonzero1;
9455 wide_int mask;
9457 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
9458 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
9459 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
9460 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
9461 else
9462 return false;
9464 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
9465 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
9466 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
9467 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
9468 else
9469 return false;
9471 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (TREE_TYPE (op0), &vr0, &may_be_nonzero0,
9472 &must_be_nonzero0))
9473 return false;
9474 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (TREE_TYPE (op1), &vr1, &may_be_nonzero1,
9475 &must_be_nonzero1))
9476 return false;
9478 switch (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt))
9480 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9481 mask = may_be_nonzero0.and_not (must_be_nonzero1);
9482 if (mask == 0)
9484 op = op0;
9485 break;
9487 mask = may_be_nonzero1.and_not (must_be_nonzero0);
9488 if (mask == 0)
9490 op = op1;
9491 break;
9493 break;
9494 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9495 mask = may_be_nonzero0.and_not (must_be_nonzero1);
9496 if (mask == 0)
9498 op = op1;
9499 break;
9501 mask = may_be_nonzero1.and_not (must_be_nonzero0);
9502 if (mask == 0)
9504 op = op0;
9505 break;
9507 break;
9508 default:
9509 gcc_unreachable ();
9512 if (op == NULL_TREE)
9513 return false;
9515 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, TREE_CODE (op), op);
9516 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi));
9517 return true;
9520 /* We are comparing trees OP0 and OP1 using COND_CODE. OP0 has
9521 a known value range VR.
9523 If there is one and only one value which will satisfy the
9524 conditional, then return that value. Else return NULL.
9526 If signed overflow must be undefined for the value to satisfy
9527 the conditional, then set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true. */
9529 static tree
9530 test_for_singularity (enum tree_code cond_code, tree op0,
9531 tree op1, value_range *vr,
9532 bool *strict_overflow_p)
9534 tree min = NULL;
9535 tree max = NULL;
9537 /* Extract minimum/maximum values which satisfy the conditional as it was
9538 written. */
9539 if (cond_code == LE_EXPR || cond_code == LT_EXPR)
9541 /* This should not be negative infinity; there is no overflow
9542 here. */
9543 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0));
9545 max = op1;
9546 if (cond_code == LT_EXPR && !is_overflow_infinity (max))
9548 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0), 1);
9549 max = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (op0), max, one);
9550 if (EXPR_P (max))
9551 TREE_NO_WARNING (max) = 1;
9554 else if (cond_code == GE_EXPR || cond_code == GT_EXPR)
9556 /* This should not be positive infinity; there is no overflow
9557 here. */
9558 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0));
9560 min = op1;
9561 if (cond_code == GT_EXPR && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
9563 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0), 1);
9564 min = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (op0), min, one);
9565 if (EXPR_P (min))
9566 TREE_NO_WARNING (min) = 1;
9570 /* Now refine the minimum and maximum values using any
9571 value range information we have for op0. */
9572 if (min && max)
9574 if (compare_values (vr->min, min) == 1)
9575 min = vr->min;
9576 if (compare_values (vr->max, max) == -1)
9577 max = vr->max;
9579 /* If the new min/max values have converged to a single value,
9580 then there is only one value which can satisfy the condition,
9581 return that value. */
9582 if (operand_equal_p (min, max, 0) && is_gimple_min_invariant (min))
9584 if ((cond_code == LE_EXPR || cond_code == LT_EXPR)
9585 && is_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
9586 *strict_overflow_p = true;
9587 if ((cond_code == GE_EXPR || cond_code == GT_EXPR)
9588 && is_overflow_infinity (vr->min))
9589 *strict_overflow_p = true;
9591 return min;
9594 return NULL;
9597 /* Return whether the value range *VR fits in an integer type specified
9598 by PRECISION and UNSIGNED_P. */
9600 static bool
9601 range_fits_type_p (value_range *vr, unsigned dest_precision, signop dest_sgn)
9603 tree src_type;
9604 unsigned src_precision;
9605 widest_int tem;
9606 signop src_sgn;
9608 /* We can only handle integral and pointer types. */
9609 src_type = TREE_TYPE (vr->min);
9610 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (src_type)
9611 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (src_type))
9612 return false;
9614 /* An extension is fine unless VR is SIGNED and dest_sgn is UNSIGNED,
9615 and so is an identity transform. */
9616 src_precision = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (vr->min));
9617 src_sgn = TYPE_SIGN (src_type);
9618 if ((src_precision < dest_precision
9619 && !(dest_sgn == UNSIGNED && src_sgn == SIGNED))
9620 || (src_precision == dest_precision && src_sgn == dest_sgn))
9621 return true;
9623 /* Now we can only handle ranges with constant bounds. */
9624 if (vr->type != VR_RANGE
9625 || TREE_CODE (vr->min) != INTEGER_CST
9626 || TREE_CODE (vr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
9627 return false;
9629 /* For sign changes, the MSB of the wide_int has to be clear.
9630 An unsigned value with its MSB set cannot be represented by
9631 a signed wide_int, while a negative value cannot be represented
9632 by an unsigned wide_int. */
9633 if (src_sgn != dest_sgn
9634 && (wi::lts_p (vr->min, 0) || wi::lts_p (vr->max, 0)))
9635 return false;
9637 /* Then we can perform the conversion on both ends and compare
9638 the result for equality. */
9639 tem = wi::ext (wi::to_widest (vr->min), dest_precision, dest_sgn);
9640 if (tem != wi::to_widest (vr->min))
9641 return false;
9642 tem = wi::ext (wi::to_widest (vr->max), dest_precision, dest_sgn);
9643 if (tem != wi::to_widest (vr->max))
9644 return false;
9646 return true;
9649 /* Simplify a conditional using a relational operator to an equality
9650 test if the range information indicates only one value can satisfy
9651 the original conditional. */
9653 static bool
9654 simplify_cond_using_ranges (gcond *stmt)
9656 tree op0 = gimple_cond_lhs (stmt);
9657 tree op1 = gimple_cond_rhs (stmt);
9658 enum tree_code cond_code = gimple_cond_code (stmt);
9660 if (cond_code != NE_EXPR
9661 && cond_code != EQ_EXPR
9662 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
9663 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0))
9664 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
9666 value_range *vr = get_value_range (op0);
9668 /* If we have range information for OP0, then we might be
9669 able to simplify this conditional. */
9670 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
9672 enum warn_strict_overflow_code wc = WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_COMPARISON;
9673 bool sop = false;
9674 tree new_tree = test_for_singularity (cond_code, op0, op1, vr, &sop);
9676 if (new_tree
9677 && (!sop || TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (op0))))
9679 if (dump_file)
9681 fprintf (dump_file, "Simplified relational ");
9682 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
9683 fprintf (dump_file, " into ");
9686 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt, EQ_EXPR);
9687 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt, op0);
9688 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt, new_tree);
9690 update_stmt (stmt);
9692 if (dump_file)
9694 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
9695 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9698 if (sop && issue_strict_overflow_warning (wc))
9700 location_t location = input_location;
9701 if (gimple_has_location (stmt))
9702 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9704 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9705 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9706 "simplifying conditional");
9709 return true;
9712 /* Try again after inverting the condition. We only deal
9713 with integral types here, so no need to worry about
9714 issues with inverting FP comparisons. */
9715 sop = false;
9716 new_tree = test_for_singularity
9717 (invert_tree_comparison (cond_code, false),
9718 op0, op1, vr, &sop);
9720 if (new_tree
9721 && (!sop || TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (op0))))
9723 if (dump_file)
9725 fprintf (dump_file, "Simplified relational ");
9726 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
9727 fprintf (dump_file, " into ");
9730 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt, NE_EXPR);
9731 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt, op0);
9732 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt, new_tree);
9734 update_stmt (stmt);
9736 if (dump_file)
9738 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
9739 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9742 if (sop && issue_strict_overflow_warning (wc))
9744 location_t location = input_location;
9745 if (gimple_has_location (stmt))
9746 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9748 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9749 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9750 "simplifying conditional");
9753 return true;
9758 /* If we have a comparison of an SSA_NAME (OP0) against a constant,
9759 see if OP0 was set by a type conversion where the source of
9760 the conversion is another SSA_NAME with a range that fits
9761 into the range of OP0's type.
9763 If so, the conversion is redundant as the earlier SSA_NAME can be
9764 used for the comparison directly if we just massage the constant in the
9765 comparison. */
9766 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
9767 && TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST)
9769 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (op0);
9770 tree innerop;
9772 if (!is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
9773 || !CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)))
9774 return false;
9776 innerop = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
9778 if (TREE_CODE (innerop) == SSA_NAME
9779 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (innerop))
9780 && !SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (innerop)
9781 && desired_pro_or_demotion_p (TREE_TYPE (innerop), TREE_TYPE (op0)))
9783 value_range *vr = get_value_range (innerop);
9785 if (range_int_cst_p (vr)
9786 && range_fits_type_p (vr,
9787 TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op0)),
9788 TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (op0)))
9789 && int_fits_type_p (op1, TREE_TYPE (innerop))
9790 /* The range must not have overflowed, or if it did overflow
9791 we must not be wrapping/trapping overflow and optimizing
9792 with strict overflow semantics. */
9793 && ((!is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
9794 && !is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
9795 || TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (innerop))))
9797 /* If the range overflowed and the user has asked for warnings
9798 when strict overflow semantics were used to optimize code,
9799 issue an appropriate warning. */
9800 if (cond_code != EQ_EXPR && cond_code != NE_EXPR
9801 && (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
9802 || is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
9803 && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_CONDITIONAL))
9805 location_t location;
9807 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
9808 location = input_location;
9809 else
9810 location = gimple_location (stmt);
9811 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
9812 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
9813 "simplifying conditional");
9816 tree newconst = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (innerop), op1);
9817 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt, innerop);
9818 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt, newconst);
9819 return true;
9824 return false;
9827 /* Simplify a switch statement using the value range of the switch
9828 argument. */
9830 static bool
9831 simplify_switch_using_ranges (gswitch *stmt)
9833 tree op = gimple_switch_index (stmt);
9834 value_range *vr = NULL;
9835 bool take_default;
9836 edge e;
9837 edge_iterator ei;
9838 size_t i = 0, j = 0, n, n2;
9839 tree vec2;
9840 switch_update su;
9841 size_t k = 1, l = 0;
9843 if (TREE_CODE (op) == SSA_NAME)
9845 vr = get_value_range (op);
9847 /* We can only handle integer ranges. */
9848 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE
9849 && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
9850 || symbolic_range_p (vr))
9851 return false;
9853 /* Find case label for min/max of the value range. */
9854 take_default = !find_case_label_ranges (stmt, vr, &i, &j, &k, &l);
9856 else if (TREE_CODE (op) == INTEGER_CST)
9858 take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, 1, op, &i);
9859 if (take_default)
9861 i = 1;
9862 j = 0;
9864 else
9866 j = i;
9869 else
9870 return false;
9872 n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
9874 /* We can truncate the case label ranges that partially overlap with OP's
9875 value range. */
9876 size_t min_idx = 1, max_idx = 0;
9877 if (vr != NULL)
9878 find_case_label_range (stmt, vr->min, vr->max, &min_idx, &max_idx);
9879 if (min_idx <= max_idx)
9881 tree min_label = gimple_switch_label (stmt, min_idx);
9882 tree max_label = gimple_switch_label (stmt, max_idx);
9884 /* Avoid changing the type of the case labels when truncating. */
9885 tree case_label_type = TREE_TYPE (CASE_LOW (min_label));
9886 tree vr_min = fold_convert (case_label_type, vr->min);
9887 tree vr_max = fold_convert (case_label_type, vr->max);
9889 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
9891 /* If OP's value range is [2,8] and the low label range is
9892 0 ... 3, truncate the label's range to 2 .. 3. */
9893 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (min_label), vr_min) < 0
9894 && CASE_HIGH (min_label) != NULL_TREE
9895 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (min_label), vr_min) >= 0)
9896 CASE_LOW (min_label) = vr_min;
9898 /* If OP's value range is [2,8] and the high label range is
9899 7 ... 10, truncate the label's range to 7 .. 8. */
9900 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (max_label), vr_max) <= 0
9901 && CASE_HIGH (max_label) != NULL_TREE
9902 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (max_label), vr_max) > 0)
9903 CASE_HIGH (max_label) = vr_max;
9905 else if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
9907 tree one_cst = build_one_cst (case_label_type);
9909 if (min_label == max_label)
9911 /* If OP's value range is ~[7,8] and the label's range is
9912 7 ... 10, truncate the label's range to 9 ... 10. */
9913 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (min_label), vr_min) == 0
9914 && CASE_HIGH (min_label) != NULL_TREE
9915 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (min_label), vr_max) > 0)
9916 CASE_LOW (min_label)
9917 = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr_max, one_cst);
9919 /* If OP's value range is ~[7,8] and the label's range is
9920 5 ... 8, truncate the label's range to 5 ... 6. */
9921 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (min_label), vr_min) < 0
9922 && CASE_HIGH (min_label) != NULL_TREE
9923 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (min_label), vr_max) == 0)
9924 CASE_HIGH (min_label)
9925 = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr_min, one_cst);
9927 else
9929 /* If OP's value range is ~[2,8] and the low label range is
9930 0 ... 3, truncate the label's range to 0 ... 1. */
9931 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (min_label), vr_min) < 0
9932 && CASE_HIGH (min_label) != NULL_TREE
9933 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (min_label), vr_min) >= 0)
9934 CASE_HIGH (min_label)
9935 = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr_min, one_cst);
9937 /* If OP's value range is ~[2,8] and the high label range is
9938 7 ... 10, truncate the label's range to 9 ... 10. */
9939 if (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (max_label), vr_max) <= 0
9940 && CASE_HIGH (max_label) != NULL_TREE
9941 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (max_label), vr_max) > 0)
9942 CASE_LOW (max_label)
9943 = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr_max, one_cst);
9947 /* Canonicalize singleton case ranges. */
9948 if (tree_int_cst_equal (CASE_LOW (min_label), CASE_HIGH (min_label)))
9949 CASE_HIGH (min_label) = NULL_TREE;
9950 if (tree_int_cst_equal (CASE_LOW (max_label), CASE_HIGH (max_label)))
9951 CASE_HIGH (max_label) = NULL_TREE;
9954 /* We can also eliminate case labels that lie completely outside OP's value
9955 range. */
9957 /* Bail out if this is just all edges taken. */
9958 if (i == 1
9959 && j == n - 1
9960 && take_default)
9961 return false;
9963 /* Build a new vector of taken case labels. */
9964 vec2 = make_tree_vec (j - i + 1 + l - k + 1 + (int)take_default);
9965 n2 = 0;
9967 /* Add the default edge, if necessary. */
9968 if (take_default)
9969 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2++) = gimple_switch_default_label (stmt);
9971 for (; i <= j; ++i, ++n2)
9972 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2) = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
9974 for (; k <= l; ++k, ++n2)
9975 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2) = gimple_switch_label (stmt, k);
9977 /* Mark needed edges. */
9978 for (i = 0; i < n2; ++i)
9980 e = find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt),
9981 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, i))));
9982 e->aux = (void *)-1;
9985 /* Queue not needed edges for later removal. */
9986 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, gimple_bb (stmt)->succs)
9988 if (e->aux == (void *)-1)
9990 e->aux = NULL;
9991 continue;
9994 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9996 fprintf (dump_file, "removing unreachable case label\n");
9998 to_remove_edges.safe_push (e);
9999 e->flags &= ~EDGE_EXECUTABLE;
10002 /* And queue an update for the stmt. */
10003 su.stmt = stmt;
10004 su.vec = vec2;
10005 to_update_switch_stmts.safe_push (su);
10006 return false;
10009 /* Simplify an integral conversion from an SSA name in STMT. */
10011 static bool
10012 simplify_conversion_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
10014 tree innerop, middleop, finaltype;
10015 gimple *def_stmt;
10016 signop inner_sgn, middle_sgn, final_sgn;
10017 unsigned inner_prec, middle_prec, final_prec;
10018 widest_int innermin, innermed, innermax, middlemin, middlemed, middlemax;
10020 finaltype = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt));
10021 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (finaltype))
10022 return false;
10023 middleop = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
10024 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (middleop);
10025 if (!is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
10026 || !CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)))
10027 return false;
10028 innerop = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
10029 if (TREE_CODE (innerop) != SSA_NAME
10030 || SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (innerop))
10031 return false;
10033 /* Get the value-range of the inner operand. Use get_range_info in
10034 case innerop was created during substitute-and-fold. */
10035 wide_int imin, imax;
10036 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (innerop))
10037 || get_range_info (innerop, &imin, &imax) != VR_RANGE)
10038 return false;
10039 innermin = widest_int::from (imin, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (innerop)));
10040 innermax = widest_int::from (imax, TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (innerop)));
10042 /* Simulate the conversion chain to check if the result is equal if
10043 the middle conversion is removed. */
10044 inner_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (innerop));
10045 middle_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (middleop));
10046 final_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (finaltype);
10048 /* If the first conversion is not injective, the second must not
10049 be widening. */
10050 if (wi::gtu_p (innermax - innermin,
10051 wi::mask <widest_int> (middle_prec, false))
10052 && middle_prec < final_prec)
10053 return false;
10054 /* We also want a medium value so that we can track the effect that
10055 narrowing conversions with sign change have. */
10056 inner_sgn = TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (innerop));
10057 if (inner_sgn == UNSIGNED)
10058 innermed = wi::shifted_mask <widest_int> (1, inner_prec - 1, false);
10059 else
10060 innermed = 0;
10061 if (wi::cmp (innermin, innermed, inner_sgn) >= 0
10062 || wi::cmp (innermed, innermax, inner_sgn) >= 0)
10063 innermed = innermin;
10065 middle_sgn = TYPE_SIGN (TREE_TYPE (middleop));
10066 middlemin = wi::ext (innermin, middle_prec, middle_sgn);
10067 middlemed = wi::ext (innermed, middle_prec, middle_sgn);
10068 middlemax = wi::ext (innermax, middle_prec, middle_sgn);
10070 /* Require that the final conversion applied to both the original
10071 and the intermediate range produces the same result. */
10072 final_sgn = TYPE_SIGN (finaltype);
10073 if (wi::ext (middlemin, final_prec, final_sgn)
10074 != wi::ext (innermin, final_prec, final_sgn)
10075 || wi::ext (middlemed, final_prec, final_sgn)
10076 != wi::ext (innermed, final_prec, final_sgn)
10077 || wi::ext (middlemax, final_prec, final_sgn)
10078 != wi::ext (innermax, final_prec, final_sgn))
10079 return false;
10081 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, innerop);
10082 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
10083 return true;
10086 /* Simplify a conversion from integral SSA name to float in STMT. */
10088 static bool
10089 simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi,
10090 gimple *stmt)
10092 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
10093 value_range *vr = get_value_range (rhs1);
10094 machine_mode fltmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt)));
10095 machine_mode mode;
10096 tree tem;
10097 gassign *conv;
10099 /* We can only handle constant ranges. */
10100 if (vr->type != VR_RANGE
10101 || TREE_CODE (vr->min) != INTEGER_CST
10102 || TREE_CODE (vr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
10103 return false;
10105 /* First check if we can use a signed type in place of an unsigned. */
10106 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))
10107 && (can_float_p (fltmode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)), 0)
10108 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10109 && range_fits_type_p (vr, TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)), SIGNED))
10110 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1));
10111 /* If we can do the conversion in the current input mode do nothing. */
10112 else if (can_float_p (fltmode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)),
10113 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10114 return false;
10115 /* Otherwise search for a mode we can use, starting from the narrowest
10116 integer mode available. */
10117 else
10119 mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
10122 /* If we cannot do a signed conversion to float from mode
10123 or if the value-range does not fit in the signed type
10124 try with a wider mode. */
10125 if (can_float_p (fltmode, mode, 0) != CODE_FOR_nothing
10126 && range_fits_type_p (vr, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode), SIGNED))
10127 break;
10129 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
10130 /* But do not widen the input. Instead leave that to the
10131 optabs expansion code. */
10132 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10133 return false;
10135 while (mode != VOIDmode);
10136 if (mode == VOIDmode)
10137 return false;
10140 /* It works, insert a truncation or sign-change before the
10141 float conversion. */
10142 tem = make_ssa_name (build_nonstandard_integer_type
10143 (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode), 0));
10144 conv = gimple_build_assign (tem, NOP_EXPR, rhs1);
10145 gsi_insert_before (gsi, conv, GSI_SAME_STMT);
10146 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, tem);
10147 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
10149 return true;
10152 /* Simplify an internal fn call using ranges if possible. */
10154 static bool
10155 simplify_internal_call_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple *stmt)
10157 enum tree_code subcode;
10158 bool is_ubsan = false;
10159 bool ovf = false;
10160 switch (gimple_call_internal_fn (stmt))
10162 case IFN_UBSAN_CHECK_ADD:
10163 subcode = PLUS_EXPR;
10164 is_ubsan = true;
10165 break;
10166 case IFN_UBSAN_CHECK_SUB:
10167 subcode = MINUS_EXPR;
10168 is_ubsan = true;
10169 break;
10170 case IFN_UBSAN_CHECK_MUL:
10171 subcode = MULT_EXPR;
10172 is_ubsan = true;
10173 break;
10174 case IFN_ADD_OVERFLOW:
10175 subcode = PLUS_EXPR;
10176 break;
10177 case IFN_SUB_OVERFLOW:
10178 subcode = MINUS_EXPR;
10179 break;
10180 case IFN_MUL_OVERFLOW:
10181 subcode = MULT_EXPR;
10182 break;
10183 default:
10184 return false;
10187 tree op0 = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
10188 tree op1 = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 1);
10189 tree type;
10190 if (is_ubsan)
10192 type = TREE_TYPE (op0);
10193 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (type))
10194 return false;
10196 else if (gimple_call_lhs (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
10197 return false;
10198 else
10199 type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (gimple_call_lhs (stmt)));
10200 if (!check_for_binary_op_overflow (subcode, type, op0, op1, &ovf)
10201 || (is_ubsan && ovf))
10202 return false;
10204 gimple *g;
10205 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
10206 if (is_ubsan)
10207 g = gimple_build_assign (gimple_call_lhs (stmt), subcode, op0, op1);
10208 else
10210 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
10211 tree utype = type;
10212 if (ovf
10213 || !useless_type_conversion_p (type, TREE_TYPE (op0))
10214 || !useless_type_conversion_p (type, TREE_TYPE (op1)))
10215 utype = build_nonstandard_integer_type (prec, 1);
10216 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == INTEGER_CST)
10217 op0 = fold_convert (utype, op0);
10218 else if (!useless_type_conversion_p (utype, TREE_TYPE (op0)))
10220 g = gimple_build_assign (make_ssa_name (utype), NOP_EXPR, op0);
10221 gimple_set_location (g, loc);
10222 gsi_insert_before (gsi, g, GSI_SAME_STMT);
10223 op0 = gimple_assign_lhs (g);
10225 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST)
10226 op1 = fold_convert (utype, op1);
10227 else if (!useless_type_conversion_p (utype, TREE_TYPE (op1)))
10229 g = gimple_build_assign (make_ssa_name (utype), NOP_EXPR, op1);
10230 gimple_set_location (g, loc);
10231 gsi_insert_before (gsi, g, GSI_SAME_STMT);
10232 op1 = gimple_assign_lhs (g);
10234 g = gimple_build_assign (make_ssa_name (utype), subcode, op0, op1);
10235 gimple_set_location (g, loc);
10236 gsi_insert_before (gsi, g, GSI_SAME_STMT);
10237 if (utype != type)
10239 g = gimple_build_assign (make_ssa_name (type), NOP_EXPR,
10240 gimple_assign_lhs (g));
10241 gimple_set_location (g, loc);
10242 gsi_insert_before (gsi, g, GSI_SAME_STMT);
10244 g = gimple_build_assign (gimple_call_lhs (stmt), COMPLEX_EXPR,
10245 gimple_assign_lhs (g),
10246 build_int_cst (type, ovf));
10248 gimple_set_location (g, loc);
10249 gsi_replace (gsi, g, false);
10250 return true;
10253 /* Return true if VAR is a two-valued variable. Set a and b with the
10254 two-values when it is true. Return false otherwise. */
10256 static bool
10257 two_valued_val_range_p (tree var, tree *a, tree *b)
10259 value_range *vr = get_value_range (var);
10260 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE
10261 && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10262 || TREE_CODE (vr->min) != INTEGER_CST
10263 || TREE_CODE (vr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
10264 return false;
10266 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
10267 && wi::sub (vr->max, vr->min) == 1)
10269 *a = vr->min;
10270 *b = vr->max;
10271 return true;
10274 /* ~[TYPE_MIN + 1, TYPE_MAX - 1] */
10275 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
10276 && wi::sub (vr->min, vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (var))) == 1
10277 && wi::sub (vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (var)), vr->max) == 1)
10279 *a = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (var));
10280 *b = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (var));
10281 return true;
10284 return false;
10287 /* Simplify STMT using ranges if possible. */
10289 static bool
10290 simplify_stmt_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi)
10292 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (*gsi);
10293 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt))
10295 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
10296 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
10297 tree rhs2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
10298 tree lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (stmt);
10299 tree val1 = NULL_TREE, val2 = NULL_TREE;
10300 use_operand_p use_p;
10301 gimple *use_stmt;
10303 /* Convert:
10304 LHS = CST BINOP VAR
10305 Where VAR is two-valued and LHS is used in GIMPLE_COND only
10307 LHS = VAR == VAL1 ? (CST BINOP VAL1) : (CST BINOP VAL2)
10309 Also handles:
10310 LHS = VAR BINOP CST
10311 Where VAR is two-valued and LHS is used in GIMPLE_COND only
10313 LHS = VAR == VAL1 ? (VAL1 BINOP CST) : (VAL2 BINOP CST) */
10315 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (rhs_code) == tcc_binary
10316 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
10317 && ((TREE_CODE (rhs1) == INTEGER_CST
10318 && TREE_CODE (rhs2) == SSA_NAME)
10319 || (TREE_CODE (rhs2) == INTEGER_CST
10320 && TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME))
10321 && single_imm_use (lhs, &use_p, &use_stmt)
10322 && gimple_code (use_stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
10325 tree new_rhs1 = NULL_TREE;
10326 tree new_rhs2 = NULL_TREE;
10327 tree cmp_var = NULL_TREE;
10329 if (TREE_CODE (rhs2) == SSA_NAME
10330 && two_valued_val_range_p (rhs2, &val1, &val2))
10332 /* Optimize RHS1 OP [VAL1, VAL2]. */
10333 new_rhs1 = int_const_binop (rhs_code, rhs1, val1);
10334 new_rhs2 = int_const_binop (rhs_code, rhs1, val2);
10335 cmp_var = rhs2;
10337 else if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
10338 && two_valued_val_range_p (rhs1, &val1, &val2))
10340 /* Optimize [VAL1, VAL2] OP RHS2. */
10341 new_rhs1 = int_const_binop (rhs_code, val1, rhs2);
10342 new_rhs2 = int_const_binop (rhs_code, val2, rhs2);
10343 cmp_var = rhs1;
10346 /* If we could not find two-vals or the optimzation is invalid as
10347 in divide by zero, new_rhs1 / new_rhs will be NULL_TREE. */
10348 if (new_rhs1 && new_rhs2)
10350 tree cond = build2 (EQ_EXPR, boolean_type_node, cmp_var, val1);
10351 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi,
10352 COND_EXPR, cond,
10353 new_rhs1,
10354 new_rhs2);
10355 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi));
10356 fold_stmt (gsi, follow_single_use_edges);
10357 return true;
10361 switch (rhs_code)
10363 case EQ_EXPR:
10364 case NE_EXPR:
10365 /* Transform EQ_EXPR, NE_EXPR into BIT_XOR_EXPR or identity
10366 if the RHS is zero or one, and the LHS are known to be boolean
10367 values. */
10368 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10369 return simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10370 break;
10372 /* Transform TRUNC_DIV_EXPR and TRUNC_MOD_EXPR into RSHIFT_EXPR
10373 and BIT_AND_EXPR respectively if the first operand is greater
10374 than zero and the second operand is an exact power of two.
10375 Also optimize TRUNC_MOD_EXPR away if the second operand is
10376 constant and the first operand already has the right value
10377 range. */
10378 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
10379 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
10380 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
10381 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10382 return simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10383 break;
10385 /* Transform ABS (X) into X or -X as appropriate. */
10386 case ABS_EXPR:
10387 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
10388 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10389 return simplify_abs_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10390 break;
10392 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
10393 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
10394 /* Optimize away BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR
10395 if all the bits being cleared are already cleared or
10396 all the bits being set are already set. */
10397 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10398 return simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10399 break;
10401 CASE_CONVERT:
10402 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
10403 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10404 return simplify_conversion_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10405 break;
10407 case FLOAT_EXPR:
10408 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
10409 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
10410 return simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10411 break;
10413 case MIN_EXPR:
10414 case MAX_EXPR:
10415 return simplify_min_or_max_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10417 default:
10418 break;
10421 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
10422 return simplify_cond_using_ranges (as_a <gcond *> (stmt));
10423 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
10424 return simplify_switch_using_ranges (as_a <gswitch *> (stmt));
10425 else if (is_gimple_call (stmt)
10426 && gimple_call_internal_p (stmt))
10427 return simplify_internal_call_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
10429 return false;
10432 /* If the statement pointed by SI has a predicate whose value can be
10433 computed using the value range information computed by VRP, compute
10434 its value and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
10436 static bool
10437 fold_predicate_in (gimple_stmt_iterator *si)
10439 bool assignment_p = false;
10440 tree val;
10441 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (*si);
10443 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
10444 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt)) == tcc_comparison)
10446 assignment_p = true;
10447 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
10448 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
10449 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt),
10450 stmt);
10452 else if (gcond *cond_stmt = dyn_cast <gcond *> (stmt))
10453 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (cond_stmt),
10454 gimple_cond_lhs (cond_stmt),
10455 gimple_cond_rhs (cond_stmt),
10456 stmt);
10457 else
10458 return false;
10460 if (val)
10462 if (assignment_p)
10463 val = fold_convert (gimple_expr_type (stmt), val);
10465 if (dump_file)
10467 fprintf (dump_file, "Folding predicate ");
10468 print_gimple_expr (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
10469 fprintf (dump_file, " to ");
10470 print_generic_expr (dump_file, val, 0);
10471 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
10474 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt))
10475 gimple_assign_set_rhs_from_tree (si, val);
10476 else
10478 gcc_assert (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND);
10479 gcond *cond_stmt = as_a <gcond *> (stmt);
10480 if (integer_zerop (val))
10481 gimple_cond_make_false (cond_stmt);
10482 else if (integer_onep (val))
10483 gimple_cond_make_true (cond_stmt);
10484 else
10485 gcc_unreachable ();
10488 return true;
10491 return false;
10494 /* Callback for substitute_and_fold folding the stmt at *SI. */
10496 static bool
10497 vrp_fold_stmt (gimple_stmt_iterator *si)
10499 if (fold_predicate_in (si))
10500 return true;
10502 return simplify_stmt_using_ranges (si);
10505 /* Unwindable const/copy equivalences. */
10506 const_and_copies *equiv_stack;
10508 /* A trivial wrapper so that we can present the generic jump threading
10509 code with a simple API for simplifying statements. STMT is the
10510 statement we want to simplify, WITHIN_STMT provides the location
10511 for any overflow warnings. */
10513 static tree
10514 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading (gimple *stmt, gimple *within_stmt,
10515 class avail_exprs_stack *avail_exprs_stack ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10517 if (gcond *cond_stmt = dyn_cast <gcond *> (stmt))
10518 return vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (cond_stmt),
10519 gimple_cond_lhs (cond_stmt),
10520 gimple_cond_rhs (cond_stmt),
10521 within_stmt);
10523 /* We simplify a switch statement by trying to determine which case label
10524 will be taken. If we are successful then we return the corresponding
10525 CASE_LABEL_EXPR. */
10526 if (gswitch *switch_stmt = dyn_cast <gswitch *> (stmt))
10528 tree op = gimple_switch_index (switch_stmt);
10529 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
10530 return NULL_TREE;
10532 value_range *vr = get_value_range (op);
10533 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10534 || symbolic_range_p (vr))
10535 return NULL_TREE;
10537 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
10539 size_t i, j;
10540 /* Get the range of labels that contain a part of the operand's
10541 value range. */
10542 find_case_label_range (switch_stmt, vr->min, vr->max, &i, &j);
10544 /* Is there only one such label? */
10545 if (i == j)
10547 tree label = gimple_switch_label (switch_stmt, i);
10549 /* The i'th label will be taken only if the value range of the
10550 operand is entirely within the bounds of this label. */
10551 if (CASE_HIGH (label) != NULL_TREE
10552 ? (tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (label), vr->min) <= 0
10553 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (label), vr->max) >= 0)
10554 : (tree_int_cst_equal (CASE_LOW (label), vr->min)
10555 && tree_int_cst_equal (vr->min, vr->max)))
10556 return label;
10559 /* If there are no such labels then the default label will be
10560 taken. */
10561 if (i > j)
10562 return gimple_switch_label (switch_stmt, 0);
10565 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10567 unsigned n = gimple_switch_num_labels (switch_stmt);
10568 tree min_label = gimple_switch_label (switch_stmt, 1);
10569 tree max_label = gimple_switch_label (switch_stmt, n - 1);
10571 /* The default label will be taken only if the anti-range of the
10572 operand is entirely outside the bounds of all the (non-default)
10573 case labels. */
10574 if (tree_int_cst_compare (vr->min, CASE_LOW (min_label)) <= 0
10575 && (CASE_HIGH (max_label) != NULL_TREE
10576 ? tree_int_cst_compare (vr->max, CASE_HIGH (max_label)) >= 0
10577 : tree_int_cst_compare (vr->max, CASE_LOW (max_label)) >= 0))
10578 return gimple_switch_label (switch_stmt, 0);
10581 return NULL_TREE;
10584 if (gassign *assign_stmt = dyn_cast <gassign *> (stmt))
10586 value_range new_vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
10587 tree lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (assign_stmt);
10589 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME
10590 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
10591 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))))
10593 extract_range_from_assignment (&new_vr, assign_stmt);
10594 if (range_int_cst_singleton_p (&new_vr))
10595 return new_vr.min;
10599 return NULL_TREE;
10602 /* Blocks which have more than one predecessor and more than
10603 one successor present jump threading opportunities, i.e.,
10604 when the block is reached from a specific predecessor, we
10605 may be able to determine which of the outgoing edges will
10606 be traversed. When this optimization applies, we are able
10607 to avoid conditionals at runtime and we may expose secondary
10608 optimization opportunities.
10610 This routine is effectively a driver for the generic jump
10611 threading code. It basically just presents the generic code
10612 with edges that may be suitable for jump threading.
10614 Unlike DOM, we do not iterate VRP if jump threading was successful.
10615 While iterating may expose new opportunities for VRP, it is expected
10616 those opportunities would be very limited and the compile time cost
10617 to expose those opportunities would be significant.
10619 As jump threading opportunities are discovered, they are registered
10620 for later realization. */
10622 static void
10623 identify_jump_threads (void)
10625 basic_block bb;
10626 gcond *dummy;
10627 int i;
10628 edge e;
10630 /* Ugh. When substituting values earlier in this pass we can
10631 wipe the dominance information. So rebuild the dominator
10632 information as we need it within the jump threading code. */
10633 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
10635 /* We do not allow VRP information to be used for jump threading
10636 across a back edge in the CFG. Otherwise it becomes too
10637 difficult to avoid eliminating loop exit tests. Of course
10638 EDGE_DFS_BACK is not accurate at this time so we have to
10639 recompute it. */
10640 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
10642 /* Do not thread across edges we are about to remove. Just marking
10643 them as EDGE_IGNORE will do. */
10644 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges, i, e)
10645 e->flags |= EDGE_IGNORE;
10647 /* Allocate our unwinder stack to unwind any temporary equivalences
10648 that might be recorded. */
10649 equiv_stack = new const_and_copies ();
10651 /* To avoid lots of silly node creation, we create a single
10652 conditional and just modify it in-place when attempting to
10653 thread jumps. */
10654 dummy = gimple_build_cond (EQ_EXPR,
10655 integer_zero_node, integer_zero_node,
10656 NULL, NULL);
10658 /* Walk through all the blocks finding those which present a
10659 potential jump threading opportunity. We could set this up
10660 as a dominator walker and record data during the walk, but
10661 I doubt it's worth the effort for the classes of jump
10662 threading opportunities we are trying to identify at this
10663 point in compilation. */
10664 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10666 gimple *last;
10668 /* If the generic jump threading code does not find this block
10669 interesting, then there is nothing to do. */
10670 if (! potentially_threadable_block (bb))
10671 continue;
10673 last = last_stmt (bb);
10675 /* We're basically looking for a switch or any kind of conditional with
10676 integral or pointer type arguments. Note the type of the second
10677 argument will be the same as the first argument, so no need to
10678 check it explicitly.
10680 We also handle the case where there are no statements in the
10681 block. This come up with forwarder blocks that are not
10682 optimized away because they lead to a loop header. But we do
10683 want to thread through them as we can sometimes thread to the
10684 loop exit which is obviously profitable. */
10685 if (!last
10686 || gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
10687 || (gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_COND
10688 && TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_lhs (last)) == SSA_NAME
10689 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last)))
10690 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last))))
10691 && (TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_rhs (last)) == SSA_NAME
10692 || is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_cond_rhs (last)))))
10694 edge_iterator ei;
10696 /* We've got a block with multiple predecessors and multiple
10697 successors which also ends in a suitable conditional or
10698 switch statement. For each predecessor, see if we can thread
10699 it to a specific successor. */
10700 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
10702 /* Do not thread across edges marked to ignoreor abnormal
10703 edges in the CFG. */
10704 if (e->flags & (EDGE_IGNORE | EDGE_COMPLEX))
10705 continue;
10707 thread_across_edge (dummy, e, true, equiv_stack, NULL,
10708 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading);
10713 /* Clear EDGE_IGNORE. */
10714 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges, i, e)
10715 e->flags &= ~EDGE_IGNORE;
10717 /* We do not actually update the CFG or SSA graphs at this point as
10718 ASSERT_EXPRs are still in the IL and cfg cleanup code does not yet
10719 handle ASSERT_EXPRs gracefully. */
10722 /* We identified all the jump threading opportunities earlier, but could
10723 not transform the CFG at that time. This routine transforms the
10724 CFG and arranges for the dominator tree to be rebuilt if necessary.
10726 Note the SSA graph update will occur during the normal TODO
10727 processing by the pass manager. */
10728 static void
10729 finalize_jump_threads (void)
10731 thread_through_all_blocks (false);
10732 delete equiv_stack;
10735 /* Free VRP lattice. */
10737 static void
10738 vrp_free_lattice ()
10740 /* Free allocated memory. */
10741 free (vr_value);
10742 free (vr_phi_edge_counts);
10743 bitmap_obstack_release (&vrp_equiv_obstack);
10744 vrp_value_range_pool.release ();
10746 /* So that we can distinguish between VRP data being available
10747 and not available. */
10748 vr_value = NULL;
10749 vr_phi_edge_counts = NULL;
10752 /* Traverse all the blocks folding conditionals with known ranges. */
10754 static void
10755 vrp_finalize (bool warn_array_bounds_p)
10757 size_t i;
10759 values_propagated = true;
10761 if (dump_file)
10763 fprintf (dump_file, "\nValue ranges after VRP:\n\n");
10764 dump_all_value_ranges (dump_file);
10765 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
10768 /* Set value range to non pointer SSA_NAMEs. */
10769 for (i = 0; i < num_vr_values; i++)
10770 if (vr_value[i])
10772 tree name = ssa_name (i);
10774 if (!name
10775 || (vr_value[i]->type == VR_VARYING)
10776 || (vr_value[i]->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
10777 || (TREE_CODE (vr_value[i]->min) != INTEGER_CST)
10778 || (TREE_CODE (vr_value[i]->max) != INTEGER_CST))
10779 continue;
10781 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name))
10782 && ((vr_value[i]->type == VR_RANGE
10783 && range_includes_zero_p (vr_value[i]->min,
10784 vr_value[i]->max) == 0)
10785 || (vr_value[i]->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
10786 && range_includes_zero_p (vr_value[i]->min,
10787 vr_value[i]->max) == 1)))
10788 set_ptr_nonnull (name);
10789 else if (!POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name)))
10790 set_range_info (name, vr_value[i]->type, vr_value[i]->min,
10791 vr_value[i]->max);
10794 substitute_and_fold (op_with_constant_singleton_value_range, vrp_fold_stmt);
10796 if (warn_array_bounds && warn_array_bounds_p)
10797 check_all_array_refs ();
10799 /* We must identify jump threading opportunities before we release
10800 the datastructures built by VRP. */
10801 identify_jump_threads ();
10804 /* evrp_dom_walker visits the basic blocks in the dominance order and set
10805 the Value Ranges (VR) for SSA_NAMEs in the scope. Use this VR to
10806 discover more VRs. */
10808 class evrp_dom_walker : public dom_walker
10810 public:
10811 evrp_dom_walker ()
10812 : dom_walker (CDI_DOMINATORS), stack (10)
10814 need_eh_cleanup = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
10816 ~evrp_dom_walker ()
10818 BITMAP_FREE (need_eh_cleanup);
10820 virtual edge before_dom_children (basic_block);
10821 virtual void after_dom_children (basic_block);
10822 void push_value_range (tree var, value_range *vr);
10823 value_range *pop_value_range (tree var);
10824 value_range *try_find_new_range (tree op, tree_code code, tree limit);
10826 /* Cond_stack holds the old VR. */
10827 auto_vec<std::pair <tree, value_range*> > stack;
10828 bitmap need_eh_cleanup;
10829 auto_vec<gimple *> stmts_to_fixup;
10830 auto_vec<gimple *> stmts_to_remove;
10833 /* Find new range for OP such that (OP CODE LIMIT) is true. */
10835 value_range *
10836 evrp_dom_walker::try_find_new_range (tree op, tree_code code, tree limit)
10838 value_range vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
10839 value_range *old_vr = get_value_range (op);
10841 /* Discover VR when condition is true. */
10842 extract_range_for_var_from_comparison_expr (op, code, op,
10843 limit, &vr);
10844 if (old_vr->type == VR_RANGE || old_vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10845 vrp_intersect_ranges (&vr, old_vr);
10846 /* If we found any usable VR, set the VR to ssa_name and create a
10847 PUSH old value in the stack with the old VR. */
10848 if (vr.type == VR_RANGE || vr.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10850 if (old_vr->type == vr.type
10851 && vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->min, vr.min)
10852 && vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->max, vr.max))
10853 return NULL;
10854 value_range *new_vr = vrp_value_range_pool.allocate ();
10855 *new_vr = vr;
10856 return new_vr;
10858 return NULL;
10861 /* See if there is any new scope is entered with new VR and set that VR to
10862 ssa_name before visiting the statements in the scope. */
10864 edge
10865 evrp_dom_walker::before_dom_children (basic_block bb)
10867 tree op0 = NULL_TREE;
10868 edge_iterator ei;
10869 edge e;
10871 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10872 fprintf (dump_file, "Visiting BB%d\n", bb->index);
10874 stack.safe_push (std::make_pair (NULL_TREE, (value_range *)NULL));
10876 edge pred_e = NULL;
10877 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
10879 /* Ignore simple backedges from this to allow recording conditions
10880 in loop headers. */
10881 if (dominated_by_p (CDI_DOMINATORS, e->src, e->dest))
10882 continue;
10883 if (! pred_e)
10884 pred_e = e;
10885 else
10887 pred_e = NULL;
10888 break;
10891 if (pred_e)
10893 gimple *stmt = last_stmt (pred_e->src);
10894 if (stmt
10895 && gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND
10896 && (op0 = gimple_cond_lhs (stmt))
10897 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
10898 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt)))
10899 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt)))))
10901 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10903 fprintf (dump_file, "Visiting controlling predicate ");
10904 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
10906 /* Entering a new scope. Try to see if we can find a VR
10907 here. */
10908 tree op1 = gimple_cond_rhs (stmt);
10909 tree_code code = gimple_cond_code (stmt);
10911 if (TREE_OVERFLOW_P (op1))
10912 op1 = drop_tree_overflow (op1);
10914 /* If condition is false, invert the cond. */
10915 if (pred_e->flags & EDGE_FALSE_VALUE)
10916 code = invert_tree_comparison (gimple_cond_code (stmt),
10917 HONOR_NANS (op0));
10918 /* Add VR when (OP0 CODE OP1) condition is true. */
10919 value_range *op0_range = try_find_new_range (op0, code, op1);
10921 /* Register ranges for y in x < y where
10922 y might have ranges that are useful. */
10923 tree limit;
10924 tree_code new_code;
10925 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME
10926 && extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (op1, code,
10927 op0, op1,
10928 false,
10929 &new_code, &limit))
10931 /* Add VR when (OP1 NEW_CODE LIMIT) condition is true. */
10932 value_range *op1_range = try_find_new_range (op1, new_code, limit);
10933 if (op1_range)
10934 push_value_range (op1, op1_range);
10937 if (op0_range)
10938 push_value_range (op0, op0_range);
10942 /* Visit PHI stmts and discover any new VRs possible. */
10943 bool has_unvisited_preds = false;
10944 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
10945 if (e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE
10946 && !(e->src->flags & BB_VISITED))
10948 has_unvisited_preds = true;
10949 break;
10952 for (gphi_iterator gpi = gsi_start_phis (bb);
10953 !gsi_end_p (gpi); gsi_next (&gpi))
10955 gphi *phi = gpi.phi ();
10956 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
10957 if (virtual_operand_p (lhs))
10958 continue;
10959 value_range vr_result = VR_INITIALIZER;
10960 bool interesting = stmt_interesting_for_vrp (phi);
10961 if (interesting && dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10963 fprintf (dump_file, "Visiting PHI node ");
10964 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, phi, 0, 0);
10966 if (!has_unvisited_preds
10967 && interesting)
10968 extract_range_from_phi_node (phi, &vr_result);
10969 else
10971 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr_result);
10972 /* When we have an unvisited executable predecessor we can't
10973 use PHI arg ranges which may be still UNDEFINED but have
10974 to use VARYING for them. But we can still resort to
10975 SCEV for loop header PHIs. */
10976 struct loop *l;
10977 if (interesting
10978 && (l = loop_containing_stmt (phi))
10979 && l->header == gimple_bb (phi))
10980 adjust_range_with_scev (&vr_result, l, phi, lhs);
10982 update_value_range (lhs, &vr_result);
10984 /* Mark PHIs whose lhs we fully propagate for removal. */
10985 tree val = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (lhs);
10986 if (val && may_propagate_copy (lhs, val))
10988 stmts_to_remove.safe_push (phi);
10989 continue;
10992 /* Set the SSA with the value range. */
10993 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
10995 if ((vr_result.type == VR_RANGE
10996 || vr_result.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
10997 && (TREE_CODE (vr_result.min) == INTEGER_CST)
10998 && (TREE_CODE (vr_result.max) == INTEGER_CST))
10999 set_range_info (lhs,
11000 vr_result.type, vr_result.min, vr_result.max);
11002 else if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
11003 && ((vr_result.type == VR_RANGE
11004 && range_includes_zero_p (vr_result.min,
11005 vr_result.max) == 0)
11006 || (vr_result.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
11007 && range_includes_zero_p (vr_result.min,
11008 vr_result.max) == 1)))
11009 set_ptr_nonnull (lhs);
11012 edge taken_edge = NULL;
11014 /* Visit all other stmts and discover any new VRs possible. */
11015 for (gimple_stmt_iterator gsi = gsi_start_bb (bb);
11016 !gsi_end_p (gsi); gsi_next (&gsi))
11018 gimple *stmt = gsi_stmt (gsi);
11019 tree output = NULL_TREE;
11020 gimple *old_stmt = stmt;
11021 bool was_noreturn = (is_gimple_call (stmt)
11022 && gimple_call_noreturn_p (stmt));
11024 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
11026 fprintf (dump_file, "Visiting stmt ");
11027 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
11030 if (gcond *cond = dyn_cast <gcond *> (stmt))
11032 vrp_visit_cond_stmt (cond, &taken_edge);
11033 if (taken_edge)
11035 if (taken_edge->flags & EDGE_TRUE_VALUE)
11036 gimple_cond_make_true (cond);
11037 else if (taken_edge->flags & EDGE_FALSE_VALUE)
11038 gimple_cond_make_false (cond);
11039 else
11040 gcc_unreachable ();
11041 update_stmt (stmt);
11044 else if (stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt))
11046 edge taken_edge;
11047 value_range vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
11048 extract_range_from_stmt (stmt, &taken_edge, &output, &vr);
11049 if (output
11050 && (vr.type == VR_RANGE || vr.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE))
11052 update_value_range (output, &vr);
11053 vr = *get_value_range (output);
11055 /* Mark stmts whose output we fully propagate for removal. */
11056 tree val;
11057 if ((val = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (output))
11058 && may_propagate_copy (output, val)
11059 && !stmt_could_throw_p (stmt)
11060 && !gimple_has_side_effects (stmt))
11062 stmts_to_remove.safe_push (stmt);
11063 continue;
11066 /* Set the SSA with the value range. */
11067 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (output)))
11069 if ((vr.type == VR_RANGE
11070 || vr.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
11071 && (TREE_CODE (vr.min) == INTEGER_CST)
11072 && (TREE_CODE (vr.max) == INTEGER_CST))
11073 set_range_info (output, vr.type, vr.min, vr.max);
11075 else if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (output))
11076 && ((vr.type == VR_RANGE
11077 && range_includes_zero_p (vr.min,
11078 vr.max) == 0)
11079 || (vr.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
11080 && range_includes_zero_p (vr.min,
11081 vr.max) == 1)))
11082 set_ptr_nonnull (output);
11084 else
11085 set_defs_to_varying (stmt);
11087 else
11088 set_defs_to_varying (stmt);
11090 /* See if we can derive a range for any of STMT's operands. */
11091 tree op;
11092 ssa_op_iter i;
11093 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
11095 tree value;
11096 enum tree_code comp_code;
11098 /* If OP is used in such a way that we can infer a value
11099 range for it, and we don't find a previous assertion for
11100 it, create a new assertion location node for OP. */
11101 if (infer_value_range (stmt, op, &comp_code, &value))
11103 /* If we are able to infer a nonzero value range for OP,
11104 then walk backwards through the use-def chain to see if OP
11105 was set via a typecast.
11106 If so, then we can also infer a nonzero value range
11107 for the operand of the NOP_EXPR. */
11108 if (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (value))
11110 tree t = op;
11111 gimple *def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
11112 while (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
11113 && CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P
11114 (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt))
11115 && TREE_CODE
11116 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)) == SSA_NAME
11117 && POINTER_TYPE_P
11118 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt))))
11120 t = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
11121 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
11123 /* Add VR when (T COMP_CODE value) condition is
11124 true. */
11125 value_range *op_range
11126 = try_find_new_range (t, comp_code, value);
11127 if (op_range)
11128 push_value_range (t, op_range);
11131 /* Add VR when (OP COMP_CODE value) condition is true. */
11132 value_range *op_range = try_find_new_range (op,
11133 comp_code, value);
11134 if (op_range)
11135 push_value_range (op, op_range);
11139 /* Try folding stmts with the VR discovered. */
11140 bool did_replace
11141 = replace_uses_in (stmt, op_with_constant_singleton_value_range);
11142 if (fold_stmt (&gsi, follow_single_use_edges)
11143 || did_replace)
11145 stmt = gsi_stmt (gsi);
11146 update_stmt (stmt);
11147 did_replace = true;
11150 if (did_replace)
11152 /* If we cleaned up EH information from the statement,
11153 remove EH edges. */
11154 if (maybe_clean_or_replace_eh_stmt (old_stmt, stmt))
11155 bitmap_set_bit (need_eh_cleanup, bb->index);
11157 /* If we turned a not noreturn call into a noreturn one
11158 schedule it for fixup. */
11159 if (!was_noreturn
11160 && is_gimple_call (stmt)
11161 && gimple_call_noreturn_p (stmt))
11162 stmts_to_fixup.safe_push (stmt);
11164 if (gimple_assign_single_p (stmt))
11166 tree rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
11167 if (TREE_CODE (rhs) == ADDR_EXPR)
11168 recompute_tree_invariant_for_addr_expr (rhs);
11173 /* Visit BB successor PHI nodes and replace PHI args. */
11174 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
11176 for (gphi_iterator gpi = gsi_start_phis (e->dest);
11177 !gsi_end_p (gpi); gsi_next (&gpi))
11179 gphi *phi = gpi.phi ();
11180 use_operand_p use_p = PHI_ARG_DEF_PTR_FROM_EDGE (phi, e);
11181 tree arg = USE_FROM_PTR (use_p);
11182 if (TREE_CODE (arg) != SSA_NAME
11183 || virtual_operand_p (arg))
11184 continue;
11185 tree val = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (arg);
11186 if (val && may_propagate_copy (arg, val))
11187 propagate_value (use_p, val);
11191 bb->flags |= BB_VISITED;
11193 return taken_edge;
11196 /* Restore/pop VRs valid only for BB when we leave BB. */
11198 void
11199 evrp_dom_walker::after_dom_children (basic_block bb ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11201 gcc_checking_assert (!stack.is_empty ());
11202 while (stack.last ().first != NULL_TREE)
11203 pop_value_range (stack.last ().first);
11204 stack.pop ();
11207 /* Push the Value Range of VAR to the stack and update it with new VR. */
11209 void
11210 evrp_dom_walker::push_value_range (tree var, value_range *vr)
11212 if (SSA_NAME_VERSION (var) >= num_vr_values)
11213 return;
11214 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
11216 fprintf (dump_file, "pushing new range for ");
11217 print_generic_expr (dump_file, var, 0);
11218 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
11219 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr);
11220 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
11222 stack.safe_push (std::make_pair (var, get_value_range (var)));
11223 vr_value[SSA_NAME_VERSION (var)] = vr;
11226 /* Pop the Value Range from the vrp_stack and update VAR with it. */
11228 value_range *
11229 evrp_dom_walker::pop_value_range (tree var)
11231 value_range *vr = stack.last ().second;
11232 gcc_checking_assert (var == stack.last ().first);
11233 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
11235 fprintf (dump_file, "popping range for ");
11236 print_generic_expr (dump_file, var, 0);
11237 fprintf (dump_file, ", restoring ");
11238 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr);
11239 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
11241 vr_value[SSA_NAME_VERSION (var)] = vr;
11242 stack.pop ();
11243 return vr;
11247 /* Main entry point for the early vrp pass which is a simplified non-iterative
11248 version of vrp where basic blocks are visited in dominance order. Value
11249 ranges discovered in early vrp will also be used by ipa-vrp. */
11251 static unsigned int
11252 execute_early_vrp ()
11254 edge e;
11255 edge_iterator ei;
11256 basic_block bb;
11258 loop_optimizer_init (LOOPS_NORMAL | LOOPS_HAVE_RECORDED_EXITS);
11259 rewrite_into_loop_closed_ssa (NULL, TODO_update_ssa);
11260 scev_initialize ();
11261 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
11262 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
11264 bb->flags &= ~BB_VISITED;
11265 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
11266 e->flags |= EDGE_EXECUTABLE;
11268 vrp_initialize_lattice ();
11270 /* Walk stmts in dominance order and propagate VRP. */
11271 evrp_dom_walker walker;
11272 walker.walk (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun));
11274 if (dump_file)
11276 fprintf (dump_file, "\nValue ranges after Early VRP:\n\n");
11277 dump_all_value_ranges (dump_file);
11278 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
11281 /* Remove stmts in reverse order to make debug stmt creation possible. */
11282 while (! walker.stmts_to_remove.is_empty ())
11284 gimple *stmt = walker.stmts_to_remove.pop ();
11285 if (dump_file && dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS)
11287 fprintf (dump_file, "Removing dead stmt ");
11288 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
11289 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
11291 gimple_stmt_iterator gsi = gsi_for_stmt (stmt);
11292 if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_PHI)
11293 remove_phi_node (&gsi, true);
11294 else
11296 unlink_stmt_vdef (stmt);
11297 gsi_remove (&gsi, true);
11298 release_defs (stmt);
11302 if (!bitmap_empty_p (walker.need_eh_cleanup))
11303 gimple_purge_all_dead_eh_edges (walker.need_eh_cleanup);
11305 /* Fixup stmts that became noreturn calls. This may require splitting
11306 blocks and thus isn't possible during the dominator walk. Do this
11307 in reverse order so we don't inadvertedly remove a stmt we want to
11308 fixup by visiting a dominating now noreturn call first. */
11309 while (!walker.stmts_to_fixup.is_empty ())
11311 gimple *stmt = walker.stmts_to_fixup.pop ();
11312 fixup_noreturn_call (stmt);
11315 vrp_free_lattice ();
11316 scev_finalize ();
11317 loop_optimizer_finalize ();
11318 return 0;
11322 /* Main entry point to VRP (Value Range Propagation). This pass is
11323 loosely based on J. R. C. Patterson, ``Accurate Static Branch
11324 Prediction by Value Range Propagation,'' in SIGPLAN Conference on
11325 Programming Language Design and Implementation, pp. 67-78, 1995.
11326 Also available at http://citeseer.ist.psu.edu/patterson95accurate.html
11328 This is essentially an SSA-CCP pass modified to deal with ranges
11329 instead of constants.
11331 While propagating ranges, we may find that two or more SSA name
11332 have equivalent, though distinct ranges. For instance,
11334 1 x_9 = p_3->a;
11335 2 p_4 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_3, p_3 != 0>
11336 3 if (p_4 == q_2)
11337 4 p_5 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_4, p_4 == q_2>;
11338 5 endif
11339 6 if (q_2)
11341 In the code above, pointer p_5 has range [q_2, q_2], but from the
11342 code we can also determine that p_5 cannot be NULL and, if q_2 had
11343 a non-varying range, p_5's range should also be compatible with it.
11345 These equivalences are created by two expressions: ASSERT_EXPR and
11346 copy operations. Since p_5 is an assertion on p_4, and p_4 was the
11347 result of another assertion, then we can use the fact that p_5 and
11348 p_4 are equivalent when evaluating p_5's range.
11350 Together with value ranges, we also propagate these equivalences
11351 between names so that we can take advantage of information from
11352 multiple ranges when doing final replacement. Note that this
11353 equivalency relation is transitive but not symmetric.
11355 In the example above, p_5 is equivalent to p_4, q_2 and p_3, but we
11356 cannot assert that q_2 is equivalent to p_5 because q_2 may be used
11357 in contexts where that assertion does not hold (e.g., in line 6).
11359 TODO, the main difference between this pass and Patterson's is that
11360 we do not propagate edge probabilities. We only compute whether
11361 edges can be taken or not. That is, instead of having a spectrum
11362 of jump probabilities between 0 and 1, we only deal with 0, 1 and
11363 DON'T KNOW. In the future, it may be worthwhile to propagate
11364 probabilities to aid branch prediction. */
11366 static unsigned int
11367 execute_vrp (bool warn_array_bounds_p)
11369 int i;
11370 edge e;
11371 switch_update *su;
11373 loop_optimizer_init (LOOPS_NORMAL | LOOPS_HAVE_RECORDED_EXITS);
11374 rewrite_into_loop_closed_ssa (NULL, TODO_update_ssa);
11375 scev_initialize ();
11377 /* ??? This ends up using stale EDGE_DFS_BACK for liveness computation.
11378 Inserting assertions may split edges which will invalidate
11379 EDGE_DFS_BACK. */
11380 insert_range_assertions ();
11382 to_remove_edges.create (10);
11383 to_update_switch_stmts.create (5);
11384 threadedge_initialize_values ();
11386 /* For visiting PHI nodes we need EDGE_DFS_BACK computed. */
11387 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
11389 vrp_initialize_lattice ();
11390 vrp_initialize ();
11391 ssa_propagate (vrp_visit_stmt, vrp_visit_phi_node);
11392 vrp_finalize (warn_array_bounds_p);
11393 vrp_free_lattice ();
11395 free_numbers_of_iterations_estimates (cfun);
11397 /* ASSERT_EXPRs must be removed before finalizing jump threads
11398 as finalizing jump threads calls the CFG cleanup code which
11399 does not properly handle ASSERT_EXPRs. */
11400 remove_range_assertions ();
11402 /* If we exposed any new variables, go ahead and put them into
11403 SSA form now, before we handle jump threading. This simplifies
11404 interactions between rewriting of _DECL nodes into SSA form
11405 and rewriting SSA_NAME nodes into SSA form after block
11406 duplication and CFG manipulation. */
11407 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa);
11409 finalize_jump_threads ();
11411 /* Remove dead edges from SWITCH_EXPR optimization. This leaves the
11412 CFG in a broken state and requires a cfg_cleanup run. */
11413 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges, i, e)
11414 remove_edge (e);
11415 /* Update SWITCH_EXPR case label vector. */
11416 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_update_switch_stmts, i, su)
11418 size_t j;
11419 size_t n = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (su->vec);
11420 tree label;
11421 gimple_switch_set_num_labels (su->stmt, n);
11422 for (j = 0; j < n; j++)
11423 gimple_switch_set_label (su->stmt, j, TREE_VEC_ELT (su->vec, j));
11424 /* As we may have replaced the default label with a regular one
11425 make sure to make it a real default label again. This ensures
11426 optimal expansion. */
11427 label = gimple_switch_label (su->stmt, 0);
11428 CASE_LOW (label) = NULL_TREE;
11429 CASE_HIGH (label) = NULL_TREE;
11432 if (to_remove_edges.length () > 0)
11434 free_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
11435 loops_state_set (LOOPS_NEED_FIXUP);
11438 to_remove_edges.release ();
11439 to_update_switch_stmts.release ();
11440 threadedge_finalize_values ();
11442 scev_finalize ();
11443 loop_optimizer_finalize ();
11444 return 0;
11447 namespace {
11449 const pass_data pass_data_vrp =
11451 GIMPLE_PASS, /* type */
11452 "vrp", /* name */
11453 OPTGROUP_NONE, /* optinfo_flags */
11454 TV_TREE_VRP, /* tv_id */
11455 PROP_ssa, /* properties_required */
11456 0, /* properties_provided */
11457 0, /* properties_destroyed */
11458 0, /* todo_flags_start */
11459 ( TODO_cleanup_cfg | TODO_update_ssa ), /* todo_flags_finish */
11462 class pass_vrp : public gimple_opt_pass
11464 public:
11465 pass_vrp (gcc::context *ctxt)
11466 : gimple_opt_pass (pass_data_vrp, ctxt), warn_array_bounds_p (false)
11469 /* opt_pass methods: */
11470 opt_pass * clone () { return new pass_vrp (m_ctxt); }
11471 void set_pass_param (unsigned int n, bool param)
11473 gcc_assert (n == 0);
11474 warn_array_bounds_p = param;
11476 virtual bool gate (function *) { return flag_tree_vrp != 0; }
11477 virtual unsigned int execute (function *)
11478 { return execute_vrp (warn_array_bounds_p); }
11480 private:
11481 bool warn_array_bounds_p;
11482 }; // class pass_vrp
11484 } // anon namespace
11486 gimple_opt_pass *
11487 make_pass_vrp (gcc::context *ctxt)
11489 return new pass_vrp (ctxt);
11492 namespace {
11494 const pass_data pass_data_early_vrp =
11496 GIMPLE_PASS, /* type */
11497 "evrp", /* name */
11498 OPTGROUP_NONE, /* optinfo_flags */
11499 TV_TREE_EARLY_VRP, /* tv_id */
11500 PROP_ssa, /* properties_required */
11501 0, /* properties_provided */
11502 0, /* properties_destroyed */
11503 0, /* todo_flags_start */
11504 ( TODO_cleanup_cfg | TODO_update_ssa | TODO_verify_all ),
11507 class pass_early_vrp : public gimple_opt_pass
11509 public:
11510 pass_early_vrp (gcc::context *ctxt)
11511 : gimple_opt_pass (pass_data_early_vrp, ctxt)
11514 /* opt_pass methods: */
11515 opt_pass * clone () { return new pass_early_vrp (m_ctxt); }
11516 virtual bool gate (function *)
11518 return flag_tree_vrp != 0;
11520 virtual unsigned int execute (function *)
11521 { return execute_early_vrp (); }
11523 }; // class pass_vrp
11524 } // anon namespace
11526 gimple_opt_pass *
11527 make_pass_early_vrp (gcc::context *ctxt)
11529 return new pass_early_vrp (ctxt);